doc/openocd.texi: Document command mode command
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2044 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2045 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2046 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2047 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2048
2049 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2050 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2051 the command can be executed in either
2052 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2053 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2054 @end deffn
2055
2056 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2057 @section Entering the Run Stage
2058
2059 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2060 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2061 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2062 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2063 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2064 You should see no errors at this point.
2065 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2066 commands you used to configure the server.
2067 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2068 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2069 on the scan chain.
2070
2071 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2072 become available.
2073 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2074 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2075 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2076 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2077 entry to the run stage.
2078
2079 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2080 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2081 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2082 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2083 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2084 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2085 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2086
2087 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2088 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2089 configuration files and/or command line options.
2090
2091 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2092 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2093 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2094 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2095 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2096
2097 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2098 corresponding subsystems:
2099 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2100 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2101 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2102 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2103 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2104 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2105 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2106 @end deffn
2107 @end deffn
2108
2109 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2110 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2111 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2112 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2113 the run stage.
2114 @end deffn
2115
2116 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2117 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2118 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2119
2120 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2121 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2122 scan chain.
2123 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2124 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2125
2126 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2127 they return.
2128 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2129 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2130 @end deffn
2131
2132 @anchor{tcpipports}
2133 @section TCP/IP Ports
2134 @cindex TCP port
2135 @cindex server
2136 @cindex port
2137 @cindex security
2138 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2139 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2140 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2141
2142 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2143 access using one or more of these ports.
2144 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2145 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2146 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2147
2148 @anchor{gdb_port}
2149 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2150 @cindex GDB server
2151 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2152 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2153 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2154 the normal use cases.
2155
2156 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2157 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2158 disables the gdb server.
2159
2160 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2161 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2162
2163 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2164 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2165 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2166
2167 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2168 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2169 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2170 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2171 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2172 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2173 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2174 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2175 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2176
2177 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2178 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2179 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2180 @end deffn
2181
2182 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2183 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2184 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2185 output from the Tcl engine.
2186 Intended as a machine interface.
2187 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2188 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2189 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2193 Specify or query the
2194 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2195 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2196 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2197 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2198 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2202 @section GDB Configuration
2203 @cindex GDB
2204 @cindex GDB configuration
2205 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2206 The ones listed here are static and global.
2207 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2208 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2209
2210 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2211 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2212 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2213 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2214 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2215 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2216 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2217 @end deffn
2218
2219 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2220 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2221 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2222 vFlash packet is received.
2223 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2227 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2228 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2229 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2230 for flash programming to work.
2231 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2232 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2236 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2237 by GDB memory read packets.
2238 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2239 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2243 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2244 packets report errors or not.
2245 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2246 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2247 @end deffn
2248
2249 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2250 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2251 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2252 @end deffn
2253
2254 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2255 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2256
2257 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2258 @end deffn
2259
2260 @anchor{eventpolling}
2261 @section Event Polling
2262
2263 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2264 where significant events can happen at any time.
2265 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2266 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2267 or to GDB.
2268
2269 Examples of such events include:
2270
2271 @itemize
2272 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2273 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2274 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2275 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2276 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2277 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2278 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2279 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2280 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2281 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2282 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2283 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2284 @end itemize
2285
2286 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2287 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2288 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2289 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2290 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2291
2292 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2293 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2294 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2295 to the various active targets.
2296 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2297 which is normally done in the background.
2298
2299 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2300 Poll the current target for its current state.
2301 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2302 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2303 specific information about the current state is printed.
2304 An optional parameter
2305 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2306
2307 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2308 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2309 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2310 @example
2311 > poll
2312 background polling: on
2313 target state: halted
2314 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2315 current mode: Supervisor
2316 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2317 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2318 >
2319 @end example
2320 @end deffn
2321
2322 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2323 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2324 @cindex config file, interface
2325 @cindex interface config file
2326
2327 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2328 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2329 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2330
2331 @quotation Note
2332 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2333 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2334 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2335 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2336 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2337 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2338 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2339 @end quotation
2340
2341 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2342 through commands in an interface configuration
2343 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2344 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2345
2346 @example
2347 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2348 @end example
2349
2350 These commands tell
2351 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2352 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2353
2354 @example
2355 # jlink interface
2356 adapter driver jlink
2357 @end example
2358
2359 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2360
2361
2362 @section Adapter Configuration
2363
2364 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2365 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2366 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2367
2368 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2369 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2370 target.
2371 @end deffn
2372
2373 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2374 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2375 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2376 @end deffn
2377 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2378 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2379 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2380 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2381 the hardware can support.
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384
2385
2386 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2387 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2388 @end deffn
2389
2390 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2391 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2392 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2393 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2394 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2395 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2396 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2397
2398 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2402 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2403 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2404 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2405 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2406 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @section Interface Drivers
2410
2411 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2412 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2413 available at run time.
2414
2415 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2416 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2417 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2418 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2419
2420 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2421 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2422 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2423 @end deffn
2424
2425 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2426 Displays status of RTCK option.
2427 Optionally sets that option first.
2428 @end deffn
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2432 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2433 This has one driver-specific command:
2434
2435 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2436 Logs some status
2437 @end deffn
2438 @end deffn
2439
2440 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2441 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2442 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2443 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2444 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2445 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2449 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2450 or v2 (USB bulk).
2451
2452 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2453 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2454 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2455 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2456 @example
2457 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2458 @end example
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2462 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2463
2464 @itemize @minus
2465 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2466 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2467 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2468 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2469 @end itemize
2470 @end deffn
2471
2472 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2473 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2474 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2475 interface string or for user class interface.
2476 @end deffn
2477
2478 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2479 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2483 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2484 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2485
2486 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2487 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2488 are logged.
2489 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2490 @end deffn
2491 @end deffn
2492
2493 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2494 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2495 @end deffn
2496
2497 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2498 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2499 @end deffn
2500
2501 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2502 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2503 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2504
2505 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2506 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2507
2508 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2509 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2510
2511 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2512 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2513 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2514 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2515 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2516 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2517
2518 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2519 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2520 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2521 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2522 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2523
2524 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2525 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2526 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2527 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2528
2529 @itemize @minus
2530 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2531 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2532 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2533 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2534 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2535 switching data and direction as necessary
2536 @end itemize
2537
2538 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2539 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2542 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2543 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2544 @example
2545 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2546 @end example
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2550 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2551 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2552 during device selection.
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2556 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2557 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2561 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2562 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2563 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2564 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2565 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2566 and initially asserted reset signals.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2570 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2571 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2572 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2573 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2574 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2575 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2576 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2577 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2578 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2579 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2580
2581 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2582 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2583 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2584 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2585 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2586 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2587
2588 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2589 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2590 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2591 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2592 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2593 are always driven by the FTDI.
2594
2595 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2596 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2597 @var{name}.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2601 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item @option{0}, drive low
2604 @item @option{1}, drive high
2605 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2606 @end itemize
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2610 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2614 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2615
2616 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2617 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2618 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2619 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2620 @itemize @minus
2621 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2622 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2623 @end itemize
2624 @end deffn
2625
2626 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2627 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2628
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2632 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2633 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2634 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2635
2636 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2637 @itemize @minus
2638 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2639 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2640 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2641 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2642 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2643 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2644 @end itemize
2645
2646 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2647 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2648 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2649 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2650 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2651 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2652 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2653 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2654
2655 FT232R
2656 @itemize @minus
2657 @item bit 7 - RI
2658 @item bit 6 - DCD
2659 @item bit 5 - DSR
2660 @item bit 4 - DTR
2661 @item bit 3 - CTS
2662 @item bit 2 - RTS
2663 @item bit 1 - RXD
2664 @item bit 0 - TXD
2665 @end itemize
2666
2667 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2668 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2671 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2672 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2676 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2677 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2681 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2685 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2689 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2693 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2697 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2701 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2705 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2706 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2707 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2708 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2709 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2710 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2711 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2712 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2713 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2714 @end deffn
2715
2716 @end deffn
2717
2718 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2719 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2720 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2721 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2722
2723 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2724 processors which are being simulated.
2725
2726 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2727 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2728 sockets instead of TCP.
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2732 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2733 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2734 @end deffn
2735
2736 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2737 something like:
2738
2739 @example
2740 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2741 remote_bitbang port 3335
2742 remote_bitbang host foobar
2743 @end example
2744
2745 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2746 named mysocket:
2747
2748 @example
2749 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2750 remote_bitbang port 0
2751 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2752 @end example
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2756 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2757 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2758 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2759
2760 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2761 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2762 default values are used.
2763 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2764 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2765 @example
2766 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2767 @end example
2768 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2769 @example
2770 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2771 @end example
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2775 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2776 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2777 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2778 target board.
2779
2780 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2781 @example
2782 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2783 reset_config srst_only
2784 @end example
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2788 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2789 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2790 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2794 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2795 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @end deffn
2799
2800 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2801 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2802 This has one driver-specific command:
2803
2804 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2805 Display either the address of the I/O port
2806 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2807 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2808 This is a write-once setting.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2813 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2814 transports.
2815
2816 @quotation Compatibility Note
2817 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2818 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2819 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2820 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2821 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2822 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2823 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2824 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2825 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2826 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2827 @end quotation
2828
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2830 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2831 states.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2834 Display free device internal memory.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2837 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2838 command version.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2841 Display the device configuration.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2844 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2845 power state.
2846 @end deffn
2847 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2848 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2851 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2852 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2853 IP configuration.
2854 @end deffn
2855 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2856 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2857 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2858 @end deffn
2859 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2860 Reset the current configuration.
2861 @end deffn
2862 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2863 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2864 @end deffn
2865 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2866 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2867 pairs.
2868
2869 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2870 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2871 @example
2872 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2873 @end example
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2876 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2877 pairs.
2878
2879 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2880 @example
2881 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2882 77a90000
2883 @end example
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2886 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2887 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2888 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2889 the serial number instead, if possible.
2890
2891 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2892 @end deffn
2893 @end deffn
2894
2895 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2896 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2897 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2898 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2899 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2900 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2901 configuration script.
2902
2903 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2904 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2905 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2906 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2907 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2908
2909 Known limitations:
2910 @itemize @bullet
2911 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2912 and 2.7 MHz.
2913 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2914 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2915 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2916 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2917 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2918 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2919 communications with the target.
2920 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2921 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2922 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2923 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2924 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2925 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2926 @end itemize
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2929 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2930 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2934 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2935 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2936 target as a side-effect.
2937 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2941 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2942 version, and target voltage.
2943 @end deffn
2944 @end deffn
2945
2946 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2947 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2948 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2949 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2950 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2951
2952 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2953 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2954 This is a write-once setting.
2955 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2956
2957 @itemize @minus
2958 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2959 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2960 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2961 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2962 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2963 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2964 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2965 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2966 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2967 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2968 some versions of
2969 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2970 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2971 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2972 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2973 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2974 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2975 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2976 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2977 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2978 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2979 @end itemize
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2983 Display either the address of the I/O port
2984 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2985 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2986 This is a write-once setting.
2987
2988 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2989 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2990 you may encounter a problem.
2991 @end deffn
2992
2993 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2994 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2995 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2996 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2997 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2998 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2999
3000 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3001 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3002 @quotation Tip
3003 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3004 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3005 @example
3006 > parport toggling_time 1000
3007 > adapter speed 500
3008 @end example
3009 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3010 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3011 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3012 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3013 large set of samples.
3014 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3015 @example
3016 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3017 @end example
3018 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3019 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3020
3021 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3022 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3023 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3024 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3025 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3026 be conservative.
3027 @end quotation
3028 @end deffn
3029
3030 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3031 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3032 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3036 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3037
3038 @example
3039 adapter driver parport
3040 parport port 0x278
3041 parport cable wiggler
3042 @end example
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3046 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3050 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3051 @end deffn
3052
3053 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3054 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3058 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3059
3060 @quotation Note
3061 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3062 which are not currently documented here.
3063 @end quotation
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @anchor{hla_interface}
3067 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3068 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3069 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3070 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3071
3072 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3073 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3074 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3075 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3076 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3077 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3078
3079 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3080 Currently Not Supported.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3084 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3088 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3089 @end deffn
3090
3091 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3092 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3093 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3094
3095 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3096 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3097 ST-LINK server software module}.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3101 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3102 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3103 @end deffn
3104 @end deffn
3105
3106 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3107 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3108 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3109 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3110 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3111
3112 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3113 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3114 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3115 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3116
3117 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3118 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3119
3120 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3121 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3122 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3125 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3126 ST-LINK server software module}.
3127
3128 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3136 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3137 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3138
3139 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3140 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3141 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3142 the target's supply voltage.
3143 @example
3144 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3145 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3146 @end example
3147 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3148 @example
3149 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3150 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3151 3.24891518738
3152 @end example
3153 @end deffn
3154 @end deffn
3155
3156 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3157 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3161 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3165 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3166 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3167 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3168 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3169
3170 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3171 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3172 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3173 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3177 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3178 version).
3179 @end deffn
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3183 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3184 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3185 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3186 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3187
3188 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3189
3190 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3191 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3192
3193 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3194 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3195
3196 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3197
3198 @end deffn
3199 @end deffn
3200
3201 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3202 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3203 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3204
3205 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3206 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3207 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3208 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3209 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3210 configuration on exit.
3211
3212 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3213
3214 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3215 pinout.
3216
3217 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3218 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3219 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3220 individually.
3221 @end deffn
3222
3223 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3224 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3225 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3226 @end deffn
3227
3228 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3229 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3230 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3231 @end deffn
3232
3233 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3234 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3235 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3239 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3240 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3244 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3245 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3246 @end deffn
3247
3248 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3249 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3250 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3254 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3255 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3259 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3260 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3261 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3265 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3269 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3270 @end deffn
3271
3272 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3273 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3274 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3275 @end deffn
3276
3277 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3278 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3279 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3280 list can be found in the
3281 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @end deffn
3285
3286 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3287 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3288 of the one which is most popular.
3289
3290 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3291
3292 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3293 pinout.
3294
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297
3298 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3299 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3300 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3301
3302 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3303 @end deffn
3304
3305
3306 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3307 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3308 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3309
3310 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3311 @end deffn
3312
3313
3314 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3315 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3316 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3317
3318 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3319 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3320 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3321
3322 @itemize @minus
3323 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3324 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3325 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3326 @end itemize
3327 @end deffn
3328
3329 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3330 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3331 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3332 @end deffn
3333 @end deffn
3334
3335
3336 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3337 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3338 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3339 DPI server interface.
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3342 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3343 @end deffn
3344
3345 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3346 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3347 @end deffn
3348 @end deffn
3349
3350
3351 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3352
3353 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3354 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3355
3356 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3357 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3358
3359 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3360 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3361 @example
3362 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3363 @end example
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3367 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3368 @example
3369 buspirate speed normal
3370 @end example
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3374 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3375 @itemize @minus
3376 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3377 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3378 @end itemize
3379 For example:
3380 @example
3381 buspirate mode normal
3382 @end example
3383 @end deffn
3384
3385 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3386 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3387 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3388 For example:
3389 @example
3390 buspirate pullup 0
3391 @end example
3392 @end deffn
3393
3394 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3395 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3396 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3397 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3398 @example
3399 buspirate vreg 0
3400 @end example
3401 @end deffn
3402
3403 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3404 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3405 @end deffn
3406 @example
3407 buspirate led 1
3408 @end example
3409
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412
3413 @section Transport Configuration
3414 @cindex Transport
3415 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3416 and the debug adapter you are using,
3417 several transports may be available to
3418 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3419 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3420 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3421 version of OpenOCD.
3422 @end deffn
3423
3424 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3425 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3426
3427 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3428 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3429 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3430 adapter's driver).
3431
3432 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3433 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3434 supported by the debug adapter.
3435
3436 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3437 transport, if any.
3438 @end deffn
3439
3440 @subsection JTAG Transport
3441 @cindex JTAG
3442 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3443 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3444 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3445 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3446 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3447 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3448
3449 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3450 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3451 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3452 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3453 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3454
3455 @subsection SWD Transport
3456 @cindex SWD
3457 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3458 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3459 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3460 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3461 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3462 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3463 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3464
3465 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3466 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3467 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3468 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3469 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3470
3471 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3472 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3473 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3474 expected to change.
3475 @end deffn
3476
3477 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3478 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3479 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3480 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3481 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3482 DAPs are created.
3483
3484 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3485 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3486 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3487
3488 @subsection SPI Transport
3489 @cindex SPI
3490 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3491 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3492 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3493 solution for flash programming.
3494
3495 @anchor{swimtransport}
3496 @subsection SWIM Transport
3497 @cindex SWIM
3498 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3499 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3500 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3501 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3502
3503 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3504
3505 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3506
3507 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3508 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3509 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3510 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3511 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3512
3513 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3514 @section JTAG Speed
3515 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3516 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3517 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3518 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3519 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3520 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3521 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3522 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3523 power management software that may be active.
3524
3525 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3526 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3527 target event handler.
3528 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3529 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3530 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3531 sets up those clocks).
3532 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3533 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3534 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3535 in the target config file.
3536 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3537 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3538 config file instead.
3539 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3540 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3541 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3542
3543 @example
3544 jtag_rclk 3000
3545 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3546 @end example
3547
3548 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3549 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3550 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3551 may not be the fastest solution.
3552
3553 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3554 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3555 which support adaptive clocking.
3556
3557 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3558 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3559 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3560 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3561 than the speed specified.
3562
3563 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3564 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3565 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3566 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3567
3568 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3569 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3570 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3571 JTAG clocking after setup.
3572 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3573 If the interface device can not
3574 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3575 @end deffn
3576
3577 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3578 @cindex adaptive clocking
3579 @cindex RTCK
3580 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3581 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3582 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3583 @example
3584 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3585 jtag_rclk 3000
3586 @end example
3587 @end defun
3588
3589 @node Reset Configuration
3590 @chapter Reset Configuration
3591 @cindex Reset Configuration
3592
3593 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3594 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3595 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3596 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3597 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3598 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3599 Please see the various board files for examples.
3600
3601 @quotation Note
3602 To maintainers and integrators:
3603 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3604 Normally the board configuration file
3605 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3606 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3607
3608 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3609 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3610 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3611 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3612 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3613 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3614 @end quotation
3615
3616 @section Types of Reset
3617
3618 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3619 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3620 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3621
3622 @itemize @bullet
3623 @item
3624 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3625 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3626 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3627 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3628 @item
3629 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3630 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3631 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3632 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3633 @item
3634 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3635 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3636 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3637 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3638 @item
3639 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3640 several other types of reset.
3641 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3642 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3643 There may be individual module resets.
3644 @end itemize
3645
3646 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3647 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3648 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3649 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3650 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3651 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3652 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3653 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3654 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3655
3656 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3657 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3658
3659 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3660 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3661 common issues are:
3662
3663 @itemize @bullet
3664
3665 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3666 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3667 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3668 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3669 when either of those signals is not connected.
3670 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3671 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3672 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3673 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3674
3675 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3676 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3677 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3678 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3679
3680 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3681 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3682 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3683 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3684 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3685 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3686 hardware debouncing.
3687 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3688 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3689
3690 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3691 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3692 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3693 to use push/pull output drivers.
3694 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3695 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3696 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3697 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3698
3699 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3700 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3701 issues (not limited to errata).
3702 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3703 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3704 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3705 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3706 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3707 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3708 @end itemize
3709
3710 There can also be other issues.
3711 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3712 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3713 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3714 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3715 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3716 Agreement (NDA).
3717
3718 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3719 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3720 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3721
3722 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3723 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3724
3725 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3726
3727 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3728 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3729 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3730 allowing it to be deasserted.
3731 @end deffn
3732
3733 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3734 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3735 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3736 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3737 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3738 @end deffn
3739
3740 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3741 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3742 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3743 allowing it to be deasserted.
3744 @end deffn
3745
3746 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3747 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3748 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3749 @end deffn
3750
3751 @anchor{reset_config}
3752 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3753 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3754 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3755 configuration scripts.
3756
3757 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3758 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3759 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3760 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3761 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3762 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3763 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3764 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3765
3766 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3767 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3768 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3769 -- may be specified at a time.
3770 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3771 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3772 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3773 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3774 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3775
3776 @itemize
3777 @item
3778 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3779 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3780 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3781 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3782 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3783
3784 @quotation Tip
3785 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3786 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3787 @end quotation
3788
3789 @item
3790 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3791 signal implementations.
3792 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3793 indicating everything behaves normally.
3794 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3795 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3796 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3797 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3798 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3799 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3800 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3801
3802 @item
3803 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3804 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3805 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3806 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3807 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3808 while SRST is asserted.
3809 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3810 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3811
3812 @item
3813 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3814 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3815 is required to use this option.
3816 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3817 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3818 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3819 be asserted before any target connection.
3820 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3821 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3822 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3823 @end itemize
3824
3825 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3826 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3827 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3828 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3829 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3830
3831 @itemize
3832 @item
3833 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3834 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3835 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3836 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3837
3838 @item
3839 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3840 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3841 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3842 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3843 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3844 @end itemize
3845 @end deffn
3846
3847 @section Custom Reset Handling
3848 @cindex events
3849
3850 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3851 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3852 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3853 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3854 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3855 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3856
3857 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3858 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3859 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3860 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3861 want to reset everything at once.
3862
3863 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3864 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3865 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3866 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3867 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3868 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3869 needs special attention.
3870
3871 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3872 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3873 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3874 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3875 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3876 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3877 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3878 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3879 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3880
3881 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3882 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3883 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3884 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3885 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3886
3887 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3888 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3889 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3890 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3891 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3892 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3893 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3894 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3895 or potentially some other value.
3896
3897 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3898 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3899 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3900 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3901 (or their associated targets)
3902 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3903
3904 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3905 they return.
3906 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3907 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3908 @end deffn
3909
3910 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3911 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3912 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3913 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3914 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3915 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3916 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3917 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3918 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3919 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3920 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3921 @end deffn
3922
3923 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3924 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3925 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3926 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3927 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3928 @end deffn
3929
3930
3931 @node TAP Declaration
3932 @chapter TAP Declaration
3933 @cindex TAP declaration
3934 @cindex TAP configuration
3935
3936 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3937 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3938
3939 @itemize @bullet
3940 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3941 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3942 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3943 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3944 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3945 start running that code.
3946 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3947 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3948 and missing connections.
3949 @end itemize
3950
3951 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3952 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3953 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3954 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3955 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3956
3957 @section Scan Chains
3958 @cindex scan chain
3959
3960 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3961 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3962 They also need to be added to
3963 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3964 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3965 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3966 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3967 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3968 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3969 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3970 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3971
3972 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3973 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3974 command, presented in the next chapter.
3975 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3976 debugging targets.)
3977 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3978
3979 @verbatim
3980 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3981 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3982 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3983 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3984 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3985 @end verbatim
3986
3987 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3988 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3989 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3990 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3991 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3992 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3993 until they are told to do so.
3994
3995 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3996 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3997 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3998 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3999
4000 @example
4001 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4002 @end example
4003
4004 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4005 by a given chip.
4006 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4007 and so forth.
4008 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4009 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4010 both inside a single chip and between them.
4011 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4012
4013 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4014 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4015 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4016 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4017 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4018 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4019 includes commands something like this:
4020
4021 @example
4022 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4023 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4024 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4025 @end example
4026
4027 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4028 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4029 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4030
4031 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4032 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4033 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4034 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4035 @example
4036 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4037 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4038 @}
4039 @end example
4040 @end deffn
4041
4042 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4043 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4044 and their status.
4045 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4046 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4047 but systems with a JTAG router can
4048 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4052 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4053
4054 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4055 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4056
4057 @section TAP Names
4058 @cindex dotted name
4059
4060 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4061 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4062 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4063 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4064 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4065 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4066 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4067 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4068
4069 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4070 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4071 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4072
4073 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4074
4075 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4076 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4077 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4078
4079 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4080 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4081 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4082 overridable.
4083
4084 @cindex TAP naming convention
4085 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4086 and should follow this convention:
4087
4088 @itemize @bullet
4089 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4090 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4091 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4092 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4093 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4094 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4095 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4096 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4097 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4098 with a single TAP;
4099 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4100 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4101 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4102 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4103 @end itemize
4104
4105 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4106
4107 @itemize @bullet
4108 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4109 @*The length in bits of the
4110 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4111 @end itemize
4112
4113 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4114
4115 @itemize @bullet
4116 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4117 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4118 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4119 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4120 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4121 (the TAP is linked in).
4122 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4123 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4124 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4125 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4126 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4127 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4128 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4129 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4130 values that were found but not included in the list.
4131
4132 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4133 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4134 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4135 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4136 hardware to find these values.
4137 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4138 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4139 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4140 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4141 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4142 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4143 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4144 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4145 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4146 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4147 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4148 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4149 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4150 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4151 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4152 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4153 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4154 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4155 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4156 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4157 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4158 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4159 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4160 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4161 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4162 @end itemize
4163 @end deffn
4164
4165 @section Other TAP commands
4166
4167 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4168 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4172 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4173 At this writing this TAP attribute
4174 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4175 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4176 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4177 See the next section for information about the available events.
4178
4179 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4180 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4181 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4182 @end deffn
4183
4184 @section TAP Events
4185 @cindex events
4186 @cindex TAP events
4187
4188 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4189 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4190 The other applies to debugger targets,
4191 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4192
4193 The TAP events currently defined are:
4194
4195 @itemize @bullet
4196 @item @b{post-reset}
4197 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4198 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4199 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4200 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4201 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4202
4203 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4204 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4205 of any particular target.
4206 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4207 @item @b{setup}
4208 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4209 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4210 @item @b{tap-disable}
4211 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4212 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4213 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4214 @item @b{tap-enable}
4215 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4216 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4217 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4218 @end itemize
4219
4220 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4221 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4222 contents to be accurate), you might:
4223
4224 @example
4225 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4226 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4227 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4228 @}
4229 @end example
4230
4231
4232 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4233 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4234 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4235 @cindex jrc
4236
4237 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4238 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4239 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4240 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4241 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4242
4243 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4244 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4245 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4246 be visible.
4247 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4248 ignores, such as:
4249
4250 @itemize
4251 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4252 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4253 TAPs receive new instructions.
4254 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4255 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4256 @end itemize
4257
4258 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4259 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4260 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4261 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4262
4263 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4264 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4265
4266 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4267 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4268 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4269 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4270 should define TAP event handlers using
4271 code that looks something like this:
4272
4273 @example
4274 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4275 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4276 @}
4277 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4278 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4279 @}
4280 @end example
4281
4282 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4283
4284 @example
4285 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4286 @end example
4287
4288 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4289 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4290 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4291 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4292
4293 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4294 If necessary, disables the tap
4295 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4296 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4297 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4298 and "0" if it is disabled.
4299 @end deffn
4300
4301 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4302 If necessary, enables the tap
4303 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4304 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4305 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4306 and "0" if it is disabled.
4307 @end deffn
4308
4309 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4310 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4311 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4312 and "0" if it is disabled.
4313
4314 @quotation Note
4315 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4316 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4317 @end quotation
4318 @end deffn
4319
4320 @anchor{autoprobing}
4321 @section Autoprobing
4322 @cindex autoprobe
4323 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4324
4325 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4326 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4327 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4328 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4329
4330 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4331 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4332 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4333 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4334 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4335 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4336 right when they come out of reset).
4337
4338 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4339
4340 @example
4341 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4342 reset_config trst_and_srst
4343 jtag_rclk 8
4344 @end example
4345
4346 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4347 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4348
4349 @enumerate
4350 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4351 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4352 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4353 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4354 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4355 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4356 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4357 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4358 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4359 that is discovered.
4360 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4361 register, it will report it.
4362 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4363 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4364 @end enumerate
4365
4366 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4367 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4368 that's a bit more complex:
4369
4370 @example
4371 clock speed 8 kHz
4372 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4373 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4374 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4375 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4376 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4377 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4378 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4379 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4380 @end example
4381
4382 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4383 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4384 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4385 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4386 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4387 and so forth.
4388
4389 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4390 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4391 @cindex DAP declaration
4392
4393 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4394 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4395 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4396 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4397 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4398
4399 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4400
4401 @anchor{dap_create}
4402 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4403 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4404 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4405 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4406 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4407
4408 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4409
4410 @itemize @bullet
4411 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4412 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4413 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4414 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4415 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4416
4417 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4418 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4419 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4420 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4421 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4422 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4423
4424 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4425 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4426 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4427 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4428 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4429 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4430 @end itemize
4431 @end deffn
4432
4433 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4434 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4435 for TCL scripting.
4436 @end deffn
4437
4438 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4439 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4440 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4444 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4445 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4446 initialization, too.
4447 @end deffn
4448
4449 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4450
4451 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4452 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4453 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4454 @end deffn
4455
4456 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4457 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4458 @end deffn
4459
4460 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4461 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4462 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4463 or set a new value @var{value}.
4464 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4465 @end deffn
4466
4467 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4468 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4469 @end deffn
4470
4471 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4472 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4473 value @var{value}.
4474
4475 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4476 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4477 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4478
4479 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4480 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4481 @end deffn
4482
4483 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4484 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4485 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4486 @end deffn
4487
4488 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4489 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4490 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4491 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4492 @end deffn
4493
4494 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4495 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4496
4497 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4498 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4499 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4500 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4501 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4502 for details.
4503
4504 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4505 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4506 the pattern:
4507 @example
4508 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4509 @end example
4510
4511 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4512 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4513 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4514 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4515 @example
4516 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4517 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4518 @end example
4519
4520 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4521 @example
4522 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4523 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4524 @end example
4525
4526 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4527 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4528
4529 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4530 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4531 example with a proper dap name:
4532 @example
4533 xxx.dap apcsw default
4534 @end example
4535 @end deffn
4536
4537 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4538 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4539 Disabled by default
4540 @end deffn
4541
4542
4543 @node CPU Configuration
4544 @chapter CPU Configuration
4545 @cindex GDB target
4546
4547 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4548 You can also access these targets without GDB
4549 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4550 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4551 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4552 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4553
4554 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4555 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4556
4557 @section Target List
4558 @cindex target, current
4559 @cindex target, list
4560
4561 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4562 where each member has a name.
4563 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4564 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4565 (plural!) command.
4566 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4567 look like with more than one:
4568 @verbatim
4569 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4570 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4571 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4572 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4573 @end verbatim
4574
4575 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4576 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4577 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4578 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4579 space seen by that current target.
4580 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4581 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4582 are examples; and there are many more.
4583
4584 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4585
4586 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4587 Returns the name of the current target.
4588 @end deffn
4589
4590 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4591 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4592 @example
4593 foreach t [target names] @{
4594 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4595 @}
4596 @end example
4597 @end deffn
4598
4599 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4600 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4601
4602 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4603 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4604 command names are singular.}
4605
4606 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4607 targets in a user friendly form.
4608
4609 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4610 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4611 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @section Target CPU Types
4615 @cindex target type
4616 @cindex CPU type
4617
4618 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4619 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4620 when calling @command{target create}.
4621 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4622 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4623 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4624 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4625 what core-specific commands may be available
4626 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4627 and more.
4628
4629 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4630 since there's a command to list them.
4631
4632 @anchor{targettypes}
4633 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4634 Lists all supported target types.
4635 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4639 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4640 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4641 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4642 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4643 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4644 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4645 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4646 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4647 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4648 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4649 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4650 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4651 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4652 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4653 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4654 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4655 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4656 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4657 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4658 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4659 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4660 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4661 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4662 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4663 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4664 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4665 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4666 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4667 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4668 support for new CPUs.
4669 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4670 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4671 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4672 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4673 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4674 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4675 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4676 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4677 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4678 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4679 @itemize @minus
4680 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4681 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4682 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4683 @end itemize
4684 And two debug interfaces cores:
4685 @itemize @minus
4686 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4687 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4688 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4689 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4690 @end itemize
4691 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4692 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4693 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4694 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4695 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4696 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4697 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4698 @end itemize
4699 @end deffn
4700
4701 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4702 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4703 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4704 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4705 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4706 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4707 reflect design generations;
4708 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4709 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4710
4711 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4712 @section Target Configuration
4713
4714 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4715 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4716 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4717 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4718 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4719
4720 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4721 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4722 optional parts.
4723 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4724 command, created as part of target creation.
4725
4726 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4727 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4728 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4729 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4730 to be much more board-specific.
4731 The key steps you use might look something like this
4732
4733 @example
4734 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4735 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4736 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4737 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4738 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4739 @end example
4740
4741 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4742 on-chip SRAM.
4743 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4744 writes to target memory;
4745 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4746 GDB memory checksumming;
4747 and more.
4748
4749 @quotation Warning
4750 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4751 inaccessible when application code
4752 (such as an operating system)
4753 enables or disables the MMU.
4754 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4755 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4756 easy access to other addresses needed.
4757 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4758 @end quotation
4759
4760 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4761 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4762 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4763 controllers.
4764 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4765 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4766 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4767
4768 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4769 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4770 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4771 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4772 purposes including additional configuration.
4773
4774 @itemize @bullet
4775 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4776 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4777 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4778 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4779
4780 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4781 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4782 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4783 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4784 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4785 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4786 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4787
4788 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4789 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4790 @end itemize
4791 @end deffn
4792
4793 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4794 The options accepted by this command may also be
4795 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4796 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4797 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4798
4799 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4800 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4801 and changing its endianness.
4802
4803 @itemize @bullet
4804
4805 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4806 used to access this target.
4807
4808 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4809 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4810 create and manage DAP instances.
4811
4812 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4813 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4814
4815 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4816 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4817 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4818 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4819 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4820 same event name assigns only one handler.
4821
4822 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4823 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4824
4825 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4826 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4827 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4828 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4829 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4830 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4831 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4832
4833 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4834 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4835 or virtual address is being used.
4836
4837 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4838 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4839
4840 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4841 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4842 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4843 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4844 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4845
4846 @anchor{rtostype}
4847 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4848 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4849 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4850 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4851 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4852 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4853
4854 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4855 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4856 access the target for debugging.
4857
4858 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4859 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4860 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4861 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4862
4863 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4864 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4865 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4866 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4867 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4868
4869 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4870 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4871 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4872 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4873 command @command{gdb_port}.
4874 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4875
4876 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4877 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4878 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4879 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4880 @end itemize
4881 @end deffn
4882
4883 @section Other $target_name Commands
4884 @cindex object command
4885
4886 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4887 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4888
4889 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4890 Once a button is created a button
4891 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4892 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4893 configure it like this:
4894
4895 @example
4896 # Create
4897 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4898 # Modify
4899 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4900 # Query
4901 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4902 # Report
4903 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4904 @end example
4905
4906 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4907 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4908
4909 @example
4910 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4911 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4912 @end example
4913
4914 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4915
4916 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4917 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4918 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4919 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4920 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4921 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4922 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4923 They are not otherwise documented here.
4924 @end deffn
4925
4926 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4927 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4928 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4929 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4930 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4931 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4932 the target side uses raw memory.
4933
4934 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4935 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4936 The script orientation comes from working with data
4937 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4938 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4939 and neither store nor return those values.
4940
4941 @itemize
4942 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4943 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4944 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4945 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4946 @end itemize
4947 @end deffn
4948
4949 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4950 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4951 @command{$target_name configure}
4952 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4953 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4954 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4955 There are a few special cases:
4956
4957 @itemize @bullet
4958 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4959 event named @var{event_name}.
4960 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4961 two parameters.
4962 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4963 This is a special case because this is set using
4964 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4965 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4966 @end itemize
4967
4968 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4969 all the targets you might use something like this:
4970
4971 @example
4972 foreach name [target names] @{
4973 set y [$name cget -endian]
4974 set z [$name cget -type]
4975 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4976 $x $name $y $z]
4977 @}
4978 @end example
4979 @end deffn
4980
4981 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4982 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4983 Displays the current target state:
4984 @code{debug-running},
4985 @code{halted},
4986 @code{reset},
4987 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4988 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4992 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4993 currently associated with this target.
4994 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4995 @end deffn
4996
4997 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4998 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4999 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5000 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5001 @end deffn
5002
5003 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5004 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5005 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5006 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5007 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5008 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5009 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5010 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5011 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5012 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5013 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5014 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5015 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5016 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5017 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5018 @end deffn
5019
5020 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5021 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5022 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5023 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5024 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5025 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5026 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5027 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5028 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5029 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5030 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5031 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5032 @end deffn
5033
5034 @anchor{targetevents}
5035 @section Target Events
5036 @cindex target events
5037 @cindex events
5038 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5039 For example:
5040 @itemize @bullet
5041 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5042 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5043 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5044 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5045 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5046 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5047 to set up system clocks or
5048 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5049 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5050 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5051 @end itemize
5052
5053 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5054 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5055 @command{target create ... -event}.
5056
5057 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5058 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5059 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5060
5061 @example
5062 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5063 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5064 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5065 @}
5066 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5067 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5068 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5069 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5070 @}
5071 @end example
5072
5073 The following target events are defined:
5074
5075 @itemize @bullet
5076 @item @b{debug-halted}
5077 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5078 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5079 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5080 @item @b{early-halted}
5081 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5082 @item @b{examine-start}
5083 @* Before target examine is called.
5084 @item @b{examine-end}
5085 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5086 @item @b{examine-fail}
5087 @* After target examine fails.
5088 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5089 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5090 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5091 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5092 connect GDB to running target.
5093 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5094 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5095 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5096 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5097 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5098 is in RAM or read only memory.
5099 Default is @code{halt}
5100 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5101 @* When GDB disconnects
5102 @item @b{gdb-end}
5103 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5104 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5105 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5106 @code{reset init})
5107 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5108 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5109 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5110 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5111 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5112 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5113 @item @b{gdb-start}
5114 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5115 @item @b{halted}
5116 @* The target has halted
5117 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5118 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5119 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5120 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5121 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5122 @item @b{reset-assert}
5123 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5124 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5125 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5126 it instead of asserting SRST.
5127 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5128 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5129 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5130 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5131 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5132 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5133 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5134 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5135 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5136 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5137 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5138 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5139 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5140 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5141 released on the scan chain.
5142 @item @b{reset-end}
5143 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5144 @item @b{reset-init}
5145 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5146 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5147
5148 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5149 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5150 multiplexing, and so on.
5151 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5152 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5153 @item @b{reset-start}
5154 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5155 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5156
5157 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5158 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5159 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5160 @item @b{resume-start}
5161 @* Before any target is resumed
5162 @item @b{resume-end}
5163 @* After all targets have resumed
5164 @item @b{resumed}
5165 @* Target has resumed
5166 @item @b{step-start}
5167 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5168 @item @b{step-end}
5169 @* After single-step has completed
5170 @item @b{trace-config}
5171 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5172 @end itemize
5173
5174 @quotation Note
5175 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5176 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5177 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5178 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5179 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5180 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5181 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5182 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5183 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5184 check if the core has changed status.
5185 @end quotation
5186
5187 @node Flash Commands
5188 @chapter Flash Commands
5189
5190 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5191 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5192 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5193 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5194 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5195 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5196 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5197 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5198 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5199
5200 Flash Steps:
5201 @enumerate
5202 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5203 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5204 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5205 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5206 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5207 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5208 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5209 @item GDB Flashing
5210 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5211 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5212 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5213 @end enumerate
5214
5215 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5216 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5217 so that it can't boot.
5218 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5219 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5220
5221 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5222 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5223 @cindex flash configuration
5224
5225 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5226 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5227 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5228 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5229 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5230 see the driver-specific documentation.
5231
5232 @itemize @bullet
5233 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5234 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5235 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5236 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5237 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5238 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5239 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5240 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5241 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5242 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5243 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5244 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5245 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5246 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5247 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5248 commands to the flash controller.
5249 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5250 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5251 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5252 for more information.
5253 @end itemize
5254 @quotation Note
5255 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5256 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5257 @end quotation
5258 @end deffn
5259
5260 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5261 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5262 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5263 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5264 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5265 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5266 @end deffn
5267
5268 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5269 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5270 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5271 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5272 @end deffn
5273
5274 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5275 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5276 depends on the flash type.
5277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5278 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5279 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5280 but most don't bother.
5281 @end deffn
5282
5283 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5284
5285 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5286 begins.
5287
5288 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5289 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5290 until the programming session is finished.
5291
5292 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5293 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5294
5295 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5296
5297 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5298 @cindex flash erasing
5299 @cindex flash reading
5300 @cindex flash writing
5301 @cindex flash programming
5302 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5303
5304 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5305 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5306 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5307 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5308 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5309
5310 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5311 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5312 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5313 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5314 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5315
5316 @quotation Note
5317 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5318 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5319 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5320 back to a flash bank.
5321 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5322 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5323 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5324 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5325 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5326 @end quotation
5327
5328 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5329 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5330 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5331 disabled first.
5332 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5333 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5334 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5335
5336 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5337 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5338 up to and including @var{last}.
5339 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5340 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5341 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5342 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5346 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5347 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5348 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5349 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5350 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5351 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5352 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5353 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5354 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5355 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5356 before erase starts.
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5360 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5361 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5362 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5363 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5364 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5365 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5366 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5367 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5368 before issuing this command.
5369 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5370 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5371 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5372 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5373 @end deffn
5374 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5375
5376 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5377 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5378 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5379 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5380 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5381 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5382 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5383 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5384 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5385 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5386 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5390 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5391 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5392 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5393 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5394 @end deffn
5395
5396 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5397 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5398 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5399 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5400 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5401 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5402 @end deffn
5403
5404 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5405 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5406 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5407 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5408 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5409 @end deffn
5410
5411 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5412 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5413 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5414 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5415 to the base address for each section in the image.
5416 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5417 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5418 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5419 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5420 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5421 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5422 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5423 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5424 each image section.
5425
5426 @quotation Warning
5427 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5428 data you want to preserve.
5429 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5430 sections might be erased with no notice.
5431 @itemize
5432 @item
5433 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5434 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5435 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5436 @item
5437 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5438 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5439 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5440 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5441 @end itemize
5442 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5443 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5444 @end quotation
5445
5446 @end deffn
5447
5448 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5449 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5450 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5451 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5452 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5453 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5454 ordinary memory reads.
5455 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5456 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5457 check for successful programming.
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @section Other Flash commands
5461 @cindex flash protection
5462
5463 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5464 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5465 and display that status.
5466 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5470 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5471 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5472
5473 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5474 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5475 and possibly stale information.
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @anchor{flashprotect}
5479 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5480 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5481 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5482 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5483 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5484 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5485 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5486 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5487 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5488 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5489 @end deffn
5490
5491 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5492 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5493 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5494 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5495 @end deffn
5496
5497 @anchor{program}
5498 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5499 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5500 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5501 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5502 @end deffn
5503
5504 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5505 @section Flash Driver List
5506 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5507 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5508 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5509
5510 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5511 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5512 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5513
5514 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5515
5516 @itemize
5517 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5518 @end itemize
5519
5520 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5521 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5522 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5523 @example
5524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5525 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5526 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5527 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5528 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5529 @end example
5530 @end deffn
5531
5532 @subsection External Flash
5533
5534 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5535 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5536 @cindex CFI
5537 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5538 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5539 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5540 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5541 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5542 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5543 configure a bus and its timings), or
5544 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5545 on the flash chip.
5546 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5547 speed up operation.
5548
5549 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5550
5551 @itemize
5552 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5553 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5554 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5555 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5556 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5557 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5558 @end itemize
5559
5560 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5561 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5562
5563 @example
5564 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5566 @end example
5567
5568 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5569 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5570 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5571
5572 @example
5573 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5574 @end example
5575
5576 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5577 @end deffn
5578
5579 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5580 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5581 @cindex SPI
5582 @cindex jtagspi
5583 @cindex bscan_spi
5584 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5585 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5586 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5587 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5588 accessed through JTAG.
5589
5590 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5591 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5592 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5593 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5594 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5595 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5596
5597 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5598 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5599 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5600 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5601 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5602 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5603 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5604 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5605
5606 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5607 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5608 command, see below.
5609
5610 @itemize
5611 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5612 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5613 @var{USER1} instruction.
5614 @end itemize
5615
5616 @example
5617 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5618 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5620 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5621 @end example
5622
5623 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5624 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5625 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5626 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5627 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5628 @example
5629 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5630 @end example
5631 @end deffn
5632
5633 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5634 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5635 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5636 @example
5637 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5638 @end example
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5642 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5643 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5644 @end deffn
5645 @end deffn
5646
5647 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5648 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5649 @cindex xcf
5650 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5651 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5652 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5653 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5654 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5655
5656 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5657 command accepts additional parameters:
5658 @itemize
5659 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5660 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5661 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5662 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5663 in master mode.
5664 @end itemize
5665 @example
5666 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5667 @end example
5668 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5669 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5670 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5671 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5672 dedicated sector.
5673 @end deffn
5674
5675 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5676 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5677 button.
5678 @example
5679 xcf configure 0
5680 @end example
5681 @end deffn
5682
5683 Additional driver notes:
5684 @itemize
5685 @item Only single revision supported.
5686 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5687 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5688 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5689 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5690 @end itemize
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5694 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5695 @cindex SPIFI
5696 @cindex lpcspifi
5697 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5698 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5699 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5700
5701 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5702 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5703 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5704 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5705 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5706
5707 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5708 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5709 are configured by the driver.
5710
5711 @example
5712 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5713 @end example
5714
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5718 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5719 @cindex SMI
5720 @cindex stmsmi
5721 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5722 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5723 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5724 SPI flash devices.
5725 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5726 flash devices can be connected.
5727
5728 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5729 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5730 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5731 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5732 the flash content.
5733
5734 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5735 to identify the memory bank.
5736 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5737 flash size, are detected automatically.
5738
5739 @example
5740 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5741 @end example
5742
5743 @end deffn
5744
5745 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5746 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5747 @cindex QuadSPI
5748 @cindex OctoSPI
5749 @cindex stmqspi
5750 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5751 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5752 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5753 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5754 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5755 mode is not.
5756
5757 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5758 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5759 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5760 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5761
5762 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5763 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5764 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5765
5766 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5767 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5768 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5769 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5770 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5771 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5772
5773 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5774 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5775 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5776 should be avoided.
5777
5778 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5779 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5780 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5781 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5782 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5783 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5784
5785 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5786 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5787 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5788 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5789 persist across openocd invocations.
5790
5791 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5792 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5793 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5794 required (see 'set' command).
5795
5796 @example
5797 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5798 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5800 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5801 @end example
5802
5803 There are three specific commands
5804 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5805 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5806 chip specific write protection engaged.
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5810 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5811 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5812 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5813 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5814 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5815
5816 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5817 which don't support an id command.
5818
5819 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5820 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5824 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5825 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5826 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5827 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5828
5829 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5830 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5831 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5832 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5833
5834 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5835
5836 To check basic communication settings, issue
5837 @example
5838 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5839 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5840 @end example
5841 for single flash mode or
5842 @example
5843 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5844 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5845 @end example
5846 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5847
5848 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5849 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5850 need a dummy address, e.g.
5851 @example
5852 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5853 @end example
5854 should return the status register contents.
5855
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5861 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5862 Microcontroller platform.
5863
5864 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5865 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5866
5867 @example
5868 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5869 @end example
5870
5871 @end deffn
5872
5873 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5874 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5875 @cindex ath79
5876 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5877 chip selects.
5878 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5879 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5880 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5881 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5882 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5883 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5884
5885 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5886 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5887 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5888 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5889 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5890 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5891 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5892 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5893 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5894 with the default CS0.
5895 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5896 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5897 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5898
5899 @example
5900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5901
5902 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5903 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5904 # distinguish the banks.
5905 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5906 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5907 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5908 @end example
5909
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5913 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5914 @cindex fespi
5915
5916 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5917
5918 @example
5919 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5920 @end example
5921 @end deffn
5922
5923 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5924
5925 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5926 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5927 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5928 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5929 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5930 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5931
5932 @example
5933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5934 @end example
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5938 @cindex ambiqmicro
5939 @cindex apollo
5940 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5941 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5942 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5943 with the target using SWD.
5944
5945 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5946 the device class of the MCU.
5947 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5948 to set up the flash banks.
5949 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5950 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5951
5952 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5953 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5954 and the second bank starts after the first.
5955
5956 @example
5957 # Flash bank 0
5958 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5959 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5961 $_TARGETNAME
5962 @end example
5963
5964 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5965 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5966 are available to the user.
5967
5968 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5969
5970 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5971 Erase entire bank.
5972 @end deffn
5973 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5974 Erase device pages.
5975 @end deffn
5976 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5977 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5978 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5979 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5980 the flash.
5981 @end deffn
5982 @end deffn
5983
5984 @anchor{at91samd}
5985 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5986 @cindex at91samd
5987 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5988 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5989
5990 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5991
5992 The devices have one flash bank:
5993
5994 @example
5995 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5996 @end example
5997
5998 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5999 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6000 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6001 processor to be halted.
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6005 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6006 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6007 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6008 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6009 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6010
6011 @example
6012 at91samd set-security enable
6013 @end example
6014 @end deffn
6015
6016 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6017 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6018 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6019 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6020 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6021 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6022 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6023 in order to disable this feature.
6024
6025 @example
6026 at91samd eeprom
6027 at91samd eeprom 1024
6028 @end example
6029 @end deffn
6030
6031 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6032 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6033 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6034 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6035 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6036 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6037
6038 @example
6039 at91samd bootloader
6040 at91samd bootloader 16384
6041 @end example
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6045 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6046 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6047 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6051 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6052 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6053 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6054 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6055 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6056 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6057 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6058
6059 @example
6060 # Read user row
6061 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6062 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6063 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6064 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6065 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6066 # byte unchanged
6067 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6068 @end example
6069 @end deffn
6070
6071 @end deffn
6072
6073 @anchor{at91sam3}
6074 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6075 @cindex at91sam3
6076 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6077 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6078 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6079 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6080 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6081 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6082 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6083 chips are confirmed.}
6084
6085 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6086 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6087 the following fixed locations:
6088
6089 @example
6090 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6091 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6092 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6093 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6094 @end example
6095
6096 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6097 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6098 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6099
6100 @itemize
6101 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6102 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6103 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6104 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6105 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6106 @end itemize
6107
6108 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6109
6110 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6111 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6112 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6113 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6114 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6115 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6116 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6117
6118 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6119 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6120 @end deffn
6121
6122 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6123 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6124 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6125 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6126 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6127 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6128 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6129 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6130 @end deffn
6131
6132 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6133 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6134 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6135 @end deffn
6136 @end deffn
6137
6138 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6139 @cindex at91sam4
6140 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6141 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6142 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6146 @cindex at91sam4l
6147 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6148 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6149 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6150
6151 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6152 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6153 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6154 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6155 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6156 @end deffn
6157 @end deffn
6158
6159 @anchor{atsame5}
6160 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6161 @cindex atsame5
6162 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6163 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6164 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6165
6166 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6167 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6168 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6169
6170 @example
6171 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6172 @end example
6173
6174 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6175 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6176 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6177 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6178 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6179 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6180
6181 @example
6182 atsame5 bootloader
6183 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6184 @end example
6185 @end deffn
6186
6187 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6188 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6189 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6190 processor to be halted.
6191 @end deffn
6192
6193 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6194 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6195 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6196 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6200 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6201 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6202 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6203 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6204 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6205 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6206 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6207
6208 @example
6209 # Read
6210 >atsame5 userpage
6211 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6212 # Write
6213 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6214 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6215 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6216 # bytes)
6217 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6218 @end example
6219 @end deffn
6220
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6224 @cindex atsamv
6225 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6226 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6227 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6228
6229 @example
6230 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6231 @end example
6232
6233 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6234 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6235 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6236 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6237 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6238
6239 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6240 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6241 @end deffn
6242
6243 @end deffn
6244
6245 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6246 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6247 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6248 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6249 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6250
6251 @example
6252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6253 @end example
6254
6255 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6256 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6257
6258 @itemize
6259 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6260 @item @var{banks}
6261 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6262 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6263 @item @var{pages_size}
6264 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6265 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6266 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6267 @end itemize
6268
6269 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6270 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6271 will be autoconfigured.
6272 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6273
6274 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6275 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6276 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6277 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6278 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6279
6280 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6281 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6282 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6283 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6284 are not truly general purpose).
6285 @quotation Note
6286 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6287 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6288 @end quotation
6289 @end deffn
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6293 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6294 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6295 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6299 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6300 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6301 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6302
6303 @example
6304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6305 @end example
6306
6307 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6308 each single sector one by one.
6309
6310 @example
6311 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6312 @end example
6313
6314 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6315 @end deffn
6316
6317 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6318 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6319 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6320 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6321 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6322 starts at address 0.
6323
6324 @example
6325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6326 @end example
6327 @end deffn
6328
6329 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6330 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6331 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6332 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6333 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6334 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6335 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6336 and programming the serial flash.
6337
6338 @example
6339 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6340 @end example
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6344 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6345 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6346 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6347 autoconfigures itself.
6348 @example
6349 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6350 @end example
6351 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6352 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6353 this via the following command:
6354 @example
6355 efm32 debuglock num
6356 @end example
6357 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6358 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6359 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6360 supported.}
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6364 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6365 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6366 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6367 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6368 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6369
6370 @example
6371 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6372 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6373 @end example
6374
6375 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6376 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6380 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6381 is an uncommon operation.}
6382 @end deffn
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6386 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6387 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6388 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6389 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6390 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6391 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6392
6393 @example
6394 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6395 @end example
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6399 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6400 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6401 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6402 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6403 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6404 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6405 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6406 characters) ignored.
6407
6408 @example
6409 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6410 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6411 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6412 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6413 @end example
6414 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6415 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6416 @end deffn
6417
6418 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6419 @cindex kinetis
6420 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6421 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6422 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6423 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6424 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6425 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6426
6427 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6428 @itemize
6429 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6430 @end itemize
6431
6432 @example
6433 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6434 @end example
6435
6436 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6437 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6438 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6439 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6443 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6444 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6445 set by 'flash protect' command.
6446 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6447 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6448 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6449 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6450 with the rest of a flash image.
6451 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6452 @end deffn
6453
6454 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6455 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6456 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6460 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6461 and examine-fail event.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6465 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6466 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6470 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6471 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6472 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6473 command completes.
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6477 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6478 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6479 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6480 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6481
6482 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6483 Program Partition command.
6484
6485 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6486 Reset the device after partition setting.
6487
6488 Show partition size:
6489 @example
6490 kinetis nvm_partition info
6491 @end example
6492
6493 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6494 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6495 @example
6496 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6497 @end example
6498
6499 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6500 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6501 @example
6502 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6503 @end example
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6507 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6508 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6509 @end deffn
6510
6511 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6512 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6513 Command disables watchdog timer.
6514 @end deffn
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6518 @cindex kinetis_ke
6519 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6520 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6521 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6522 autoconfigures itself.
6523 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6524
6525 @example
6526 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6527 @end example
6528
6529 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6530 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6534 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6535 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6536 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6537 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6541 Command disables watchdog timer.
6542 @end deffn
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6546 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6547 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6548 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6549 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6550
6551 @quotation Note
6552 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6553 driver:
6554 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6555 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6556 @end quotation
6557
6558 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6559 which must appear in the following order:
6560
6561 @itemize
6562 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6563 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6564 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6565 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6566 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6567 LPC43x[2357])
6568 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6569 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6570 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6571 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6572 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6573 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6574 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6575 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6576 at which the core is running
6577 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6578 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6579 @quotation Note
6580 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6581 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6582 However, if you do provide it,
6583 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6584 @end quotation
6585 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6586 ROM IAP entry point.
6587 @end itemize
6588
6589 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6590
6591 @example
6592 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6593 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6594 @end example
6595
6596 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6597 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6598 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6599 @end deffn
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6603 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6604 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6605 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6606 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6607 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6608
6609 @example
6610 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6611 @end example
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6615 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6616 from NXP.
6617
6618 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6619 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6620 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6621 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6622 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6623 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6624 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6625 you start the PLL.
6626
6627 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6628
6629 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6630 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6631 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6632
6633 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6634 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6635 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6636 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6637 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6638 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6639 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6640
6641 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6642 @example
6643 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6644 @end example
6645
6646 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6647 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6648 @code{flash banks} command.
6649
6650 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6651 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6652 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6653 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6654 a known signature.
6655 Example:
6656 @example
6657 lpc2900 signature 0
6658 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6659 @end example
6660 @end deffn
6661
6662 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6663 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6664 saves it to a file in binary format.
6665 Example:
6666 @example
6667 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6668 @end example
6669 @end deffn
6670
6671 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6672 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6673 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6674 command:
6675
6676 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6677 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6678 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6679 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6680
6681 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6682 Example:
6683 @example
6684 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6685 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6686 @end example
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6690 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6691 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6692 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6693 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6694 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6695 912 bytes.
6696 @quotation Attention
6697 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6698 @end quotation
6699 Example:
6700 @example
6701 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6702 @end example
6703 @end deffn
6704
6705 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6706 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6707 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6708 after the next power cycle.
6709 @quotation Attention
6710 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6711 @end quotation
6712 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6713 Example:
6714 @example
6715 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6716 flash info 0
6717 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6718 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6719 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6720 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6721 @end example
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6725 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6726 effective after the next power cycle.
6727 @quotation Attention
6728 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6729 @end quotation
6730 Examples:
6731 @example
6732 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6733 @end example
6734 @end deffn
6735 @end deffn
6736
6737 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6738 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6739 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6740 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6741
6742 @example
6743 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6744 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6745 @end example
6746
6747 @itemize @bullet
6748 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6749 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6750 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6751 @end itemize
6752
6753 Example usage:
6754 @example
6755 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6756 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6757 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6758 @} else @{
6759 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6760 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6761 @}
6762 @end example
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6766 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6767 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6768 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6769 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6770 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6771
6772 @example
6773 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6774 @end example
6775
6776 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6777 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6778 only the main program flash.
6779
6780 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6781 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6782 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6786 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6787 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6788 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6789
6790 To erase and program the BSL:
6791 @example
6792 msp432 bsl unlock
6793 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6794 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6795 msp432 bsl lock
6796 @end example
6797 @end deffn
6798 @end deffn
6799
6800 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6801 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6802 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6803 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6804 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6805 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6806 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6807 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6808 also have division into regions: main and info.
6809 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6810 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6811
6812 @example
6813 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6814 @end example
6815
6816 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6817
6818 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6819 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6823 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6827 Erase all userflash including info region.
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6831 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6835 Check sectors protect.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6839 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6843 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6847 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6851 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6852 @end deffn
6853
6854 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6855 Show information about flash driver.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6861 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6862 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6863 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6864 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6865
6866 @example
6867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6868 @end example
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6872 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6873 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
6874 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
6875 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
6876 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
6877 - ACL).
6878
6879 @example
6880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6881 @end example
6882
6883 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6884
6885 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6886 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6887 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6888 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6889 code.
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6893 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @end deffn
6897
6898 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6899 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6900 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6901
6902 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6903 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6904 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6905 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6906
6907 @example
6908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6909 @end example
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6913 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6914 and integrate flash memory.
6915
6916 @example
6917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6918 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6919 @end example
6920
6921 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6922 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6923 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6924 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6925 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6926 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6927 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6928 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6929 @end deffn
6930 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6931 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6932 This will remove any Code Protection.
6933 @end deffn
6934 @end deffn
6935
6936 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6937 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6938 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6939 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6940 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6941
6942 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6943 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6944
6945 @example
6946 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6947 @end example
6948
6949 psoc4-specific commands
6950 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6951 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6952
6953 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6954 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6955
6956 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6957 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6958 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6959
6960 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6964 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6965
6966 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6967 @end deffn
6968 @end deffn
6969
6970 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6971 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6972 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6973 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6974 apart from the base address.
6975
6976 @example
6977 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6978 @end example
6979
6980 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6981 @quotation Attention
6982 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6983 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6984 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6985 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6986 @end quotation
6987
6988 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6989
6990 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6991 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6992 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6993 @end deffn
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6997 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6998 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6999 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7000 apart from the base address.
7001
7002 @example
7003 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7004 $_TARGETNAME
7005 @end example
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7009 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7010 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7011 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7012
7013 @example
7014 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7015 @end example
7016
7017 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7018
7019 @itemize
7020 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7021 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7022 @end itemize
7023
7024 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7025
7026 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7027 @quotation Attention
7028 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7029 after successful write.
7030 @end quotation
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7034 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7035 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7036 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7037
7038 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7039 @itemize @bullet
7040 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7041 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7042 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7043 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7044 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7045 row size: 512 bytes.
7046 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7047 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7048 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7049 operation will erase row automatically.
7050 @end itemize
7051
7052 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7053 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7054
7055 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7056
7057 @example
7058 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7059 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7060 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7061 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7062 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7063 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7064 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7065 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7066 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7067 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7068 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7069 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7070
7071 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7072 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7073 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7074 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7075 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7076 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7077 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7078 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7079 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7080 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7081 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7082 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7083 @end example
7084
7085 psoc6-specific commands
7086 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7087 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7088 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7089 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7090 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7091 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7092 @end deffn
7093
7094 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7095 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7096 by @command{flash banks}.
7097 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7098 @end deffn
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7102 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7103 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7104 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7105 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7106
7107 @example
7108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7109 @end example
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7113 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7114 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7115 and SWD interface.
7116 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7117 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7118
7119 @example
7120 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7121 @end example
7122
7123 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7124
7125 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7126 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7127 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7131 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7132 @end deffn
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7136 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7137 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7138 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7139 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7140
7141 @example
7142 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7143 @end example
7144
7145 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7146 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7147 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7148 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7149 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7150 disabled.
7151
7152 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7153 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7154 @quotation Warning
7155 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7156 applied to all of them.
7157 @end quotation
7158 @end deffn
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7162 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7163 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7164 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7165 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7166 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7167
7168 @example
7169 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7170 @end example
7171
7172 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7173 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7174 the flash driver.
7175
7176 @example
7177 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7178 @end example
7179
7180 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7181 as per the following example.
7182 @example
7183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7184 @end example
7185
7186 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7187
7188 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7189 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7190 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7194 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7195 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7200 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7201 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7205 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7206 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7207 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7211 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7212 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7213 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7214 @end deffn
7215
7216 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7217 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7218 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7219 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7220 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7221 @end deffn
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7225 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7226 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7227 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7228 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7229
7230 @example
7231 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7232 @end example
7233
7234 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7235 as per the following example.
7236 @example
7237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7238 @end example
7239
7240 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7241 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7246 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7247 the flash driver.
7248
7249 @example
7250 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7251 @end example
7252
7253 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7254
7255 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7256 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7257 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7258 @end deffn
7259
7260 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7261 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7262 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7266 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7267 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7271 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7276 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7277 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7278 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7279 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7280 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7281 @end deffn
7282
7283 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7284 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7285 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7286 @end deffn
7287 @end deffn
7288
7289 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7290 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7291 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7292 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7293 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7294
7295 @example
7296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7297 @end example
7298
7299 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7300 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7301 the flash driver.
7302
7303 @example
7304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7305 @end example
7306
7307 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7308
7309 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7310 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7311 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7315 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7316 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7320 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7321 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7322 @end deffn
7323
7324 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7325 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7327 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7328 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7329
7330 Example usage:
7331 @example
7332 # read OPTSR_CUR
7333 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7334 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7335 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7336 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7337 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7338 @end example
7339 @end deffn
7340
7341 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7342 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7343 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7344 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7345 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7346 will be touched).
7347
7348 Example usage:
7349 @example
7350 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7351 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7352 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7353 @end example
7354 @end deffn
7355 @end deffn
7356
7357 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7358 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7359 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7360 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7361 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7362
7363 @example
7364 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7365 @end example
7366
7367 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7368 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7369 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7370 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7371 second bank.
7372
7373 @example
7374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7375 @end example
7376
7377 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7378
7379 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7380 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7381 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7385 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7386 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7390 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7391 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7392 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7393 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7394 @end deffn
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7398 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7399 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7400 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7401 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7402 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7403
7404 @example
7405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7406 @end example
7407
7408 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7409 as per the following example.
7410 @example
7411 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7412 @end example
7413
7414 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7415 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7416 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7420 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7421 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7422 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7423
7424 @example
7425 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7426 @end example
7427
7428 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7429
7430 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7431 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7432 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7433
7434 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7438 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7439 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7440
7441 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7442 @end deffn
7443
7444 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7445 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7446 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7447 @end deffn
7448
7449 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7450 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7451 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7452 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7453
7454 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7455 @example
7456 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7457 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7458 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7459 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7460 @end example
7461
7462 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7463 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7464 @end deffn
7465
7466 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7467 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7468 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7469 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7470 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7471
7472 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7473
7474 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7475 @example
7476 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7477 @end example
7478
7479 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7480 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7481 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7485 List the protected areas using WRP.
7486 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7487 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7488 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7489
7490 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7491 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7492 in single or dual-banks mode.
7493 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7494 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7495
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7499 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7500 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7504 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7505 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7506 the TrustZone status.
7507 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7508 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7509 @end deffn
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7513 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7514 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7515 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7516 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7517
7518 @example
7519 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7520 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7521 @end example
7522
7523 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7524 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7525 for the specified flash bank.
7526 @end deffn
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7530 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7531 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7532 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7533 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7534
7535 @example
7536 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7537 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7538 @end example
7539
7540 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7541 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7542 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7543
7544 @itemize @bullet
7545 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7546 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7547 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7548 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7549 @end itemize
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7555 @cindex str9xpec
7556
7557 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7558 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7559 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7560 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7561
7562 Here is some background info to help
7563 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7564 the str9:
7565 @enumerate
7566 @item
7567 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7568 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7569 @item
7570 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7571 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7572 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7573 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7574 @end enumerate
7575
7576 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7577 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7578 configured for flash bank 0.
7579 @example
7580 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7581 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7582 adapter assert srst
7583 # turn off target polling
7584 poll off
7585 # disable str9 core
7586 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7587 # read option bytes
7588 str9xpec options_read 0
7589 # re-enable str9 core
7590 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7591 poll on
7592 reset halt
7593 @end example
7594 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7595 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7596 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7597 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7598
7599 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7602 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7606 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7607 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7611 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7612 erase the device.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7616 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7617 @end deffn
7618
7619 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7620 Configure str9 boot bank.
7621 @end deffn
7622
7623 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7624 Configure str9 lvd source.
7625 @end deffn
7626
7627 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7628 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7629 @end deffn
7630
7631 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7632 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7633 @end deffn
7634
7635 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7636 Read str9 option bytes.
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7640 Write str9 option bytes.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7644 unlock str9 device.
7645 @end deffn
7646
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7650 @cindex swm050
7651 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7652
7653 @example
7654 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7655 @end example
7656
7657 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7658
7659 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7660 Erases the entire flash bank.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @end deffn
7664
7665
7666 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7667 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7668 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7669 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7670
7671 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7672
7673 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7674 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7675 @end deffn
7676
7677 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7678 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7679 @end deffn
7680
7681 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7682 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7683 the flash clock.
7684 @end deffn
7685 @end deffn
7686
7687 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7688 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7689 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7690 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7691 correct bank config.
7692
7693 @example
7694 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7695 @end example
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7699 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7700 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7701 @end deffn
7702
7703 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7704 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7705 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7706
7707 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7708
7709 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7710 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7714 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719 @section NAND Flash Commands
7720 @cindex NAND
7721
7722 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7723 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7724 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7725
7726 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7727 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7728 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7729 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7730 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7731 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7732
7733 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7734 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7735 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7736 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7737 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7738 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7739 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7740 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7741 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7742 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7743
7744 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7745 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7746 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7747 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7748 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7749 every 512 bytes of data.
7750
7751 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7752 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7753 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7754 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7755 ECC mode is used.
7756
7757 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7758 @enumerate
7759 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7760 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7761 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7762 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7763 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7764 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7765 to access that device.
7766 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7767 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7768 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7769 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7770 de-brick a board.
7771 @end enumerate
7772
7773 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7774 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7775 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7776 are only 32 bits wide.
7777 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7778 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7779 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7780 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7781
7782 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7783 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7784 @cindex NAND configuration
7785
7786 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7787 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7788 OpenOCD has initialized.
7789
7790 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7791 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7792 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7793 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7794 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7795 they were a single (larger) device.
7796 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7797 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7798
7799 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7800 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7801 configuration files, not interactively.
7802
7803 @itemize @bullet
7804 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7805 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7806 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7807 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7808 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7809 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7810 commands to the NAND controller.
7811 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7812 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7813 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7814 for more information.
7815 @end itemize
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7819 Prints a summary of each device declared
7820 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7821 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7822 @example
7823 > nand list
7824 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7825 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7826 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7827 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7828 >
7829 @end example
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7833 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7834 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7835 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7836 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7837 it with most other NAND commands.
7838 @end deffn
7839
7840 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7841
7842 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7843 @cindex NAND reading
7844 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7845 starting at the specified offset.
7846 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7847
7848 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7849 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7850
7851 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7852 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7853 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7854
7855 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7856 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7857 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7858 method which handled that error correction.
7859
7860 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7861 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7862 @itemize @bullet
7863 @item no oob_* parameter
7864 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7865 @item @code{oob_raw}
7866 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7867 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7868 spare areas associated with each data page.
7869 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7870 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7871 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7872 @item @code{oob_only}
7873 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7874 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7875 spare areas associated with each data page.
7876 @end itemize
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7880 @cindex NAND erasing
7881 @cindex NAND programming
7882 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7883 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7884 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7885 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7886 If those parameters are not specified,
7887 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7888 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7889
7890 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7891 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7892 block marker.
7893 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7894 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7898 @cindex NAND writing
7899 @cindex NAND programming
7900 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7901 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7902 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7903 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7904
7905 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7906 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7907
7908 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7909 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7910 past the end of the device.
7911 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7912 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7913 if that's being written.)
7914
7915 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7916 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7917 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7918
7919 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7920 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7921 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7922 @itemize @bullet
7923 @item no oob_* parameter
7924 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7925 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7926 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7927 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7928 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7929 @item @code{oob_only}
7930 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7931 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7932 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7933 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7934 @item @code{oob_raw}
7935 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7936 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7937 un-altered OOB.
7938 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7939 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7940 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7941 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7942 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7943 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7944 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7945 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7946 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7947 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7948 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7949 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7950 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7951 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7952 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7953 @end itemize
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7957 @cindex NAND verification
7958 @cindex NAND programming
7959 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7960 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7961 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7962
7963 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7964 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7965
7966 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7967 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7968 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7969 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7970 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7971
7972 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7973 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7974 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7975
7976 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7977 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7978 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7979 be removed in a future release.
7980 @end deffn
7981
7982 @subsection Other NAND commands
7983 @cindex NAND other commands
7984
7985 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7986 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7987 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7988 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7989 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7990 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7991 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7992 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7993
7994 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7995 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7996 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8000 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8001 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8002 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8003 status for each block.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8007 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8008 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8009
8010 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8011 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8012 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8013 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8014 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8015
8016 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8017 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8018 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8019 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8020 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8021 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8022 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8026 @subsection NAND Driver List
8027 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8028 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8029 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8030
8031 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8032 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8033 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8034 address of the ECC controller.
8035 @example
8036 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8037 @end example
8038 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8039 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8040 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8041 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8042 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8043 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8044 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8045 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8046 @end deffn
8047 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8048 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8049 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8050 @end deffn
8051
8052 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8053 properly configured for input or output.
8054 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8055 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8056 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8057 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8058 @end deffn
8059 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8060 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8061 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8062 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8063 @end deffn
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8067 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8068 chips from Texas Instruments.
8069 It takes three extra parameters:
8070 address of the NAND chip;
8071 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8072 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8073 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8074 @example
8075 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8076 @end example
8077 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8078 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8079 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8080 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8081 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8082 @end deffn
8083
8084 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8085 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8086 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8087 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8088 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8089 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8090 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8091 @end deffn
8092
8093 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8094 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8095 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8096 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8097 @end deffn
8098 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8099
8100 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8101 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8102 should work for this chip as well.
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8106 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8107 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8108 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8109 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8110 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8111 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8112 @example
8113 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8114 @end example
8115 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8116 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8117 without parameter query status.
8118 @end deffn
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8122 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8123 parameter: the address of the controller.
8124 @example
8125 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8126 @end example
8127 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8128 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8129 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8130 change any behavior.
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8134 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8135 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8136 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8137 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8138 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8139 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8140 specialized commands.
8141 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8142 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8143 change any behavior.
8144 @end deffn
8145
8146 @node Flash Programming
8147 @chapter Flash Programming
8148
8149 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8150 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8151 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8152
8153 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8154 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8155
8156 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8157 @enumerate
8158 @item 'init' is executed.
8159 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8160 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8161 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8162 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8163 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8164 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8165 @end enumerate
8166
8167 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8168
8169 @example
8170 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8171 # are optional parameters
8172 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8173 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8174
8175 # binary files need the flash address passing
8176 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8177 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8178 @end example
8179
8180 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8181 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8182 @cindex PLD
8183 @cindex FPGA
8184
8185 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8186 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8187 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8188 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8189 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8190 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8191 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8192
8193 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8194
8195 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8196 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8197 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8198
8199 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8200 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8201
8202 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8203 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8204 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8205 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8206 behavior.
8207 @end deffn
8208
8209 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8210 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8214 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8215 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8216 @end deffn
8217
8218 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8219
8220 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8221 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8222 that particular type of PLD.
8223
8224 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8225 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8226 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8227
8228 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8229 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8230 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8231
8232 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8233 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8234 for FPGA @var{num}.
8235 @end deffn
8236 @end deffn
8237
8238 @node General Commands
8239 @chapter General Commands
8240 @cindex commands
8241
8242 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8243 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8244 commands are documented elsewhere.
8245
8246 Intent:
8247 @itemize @bullet
8248 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8249 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8250 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8251 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8252
8253 @item @b{From the human}
8254 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8255 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8256
8257 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8258 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8259 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8260
8261 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8262 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8263 port is 5555.
8264 @end itemize
8265
8266
8267 @section Server Commands
8268
8269 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8270 Exits the current telnet session.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8274 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8275 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8276 Not every command provides helptext.
8277
8278 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8279 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8280 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8281 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8282 @end deffn
8283
8284 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8285 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8286 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8287 containing @var{string}.
8288 Not every command provides helptext.
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8292 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8293 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8294 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8295 Useful in connection with script files
8296 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8300 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8301 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8302 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8303
8304 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8305 @example
8306 # redefine shutdown
8307 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8308 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8309 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8310 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8311 original_shutdown
8312 @}
8313 @end example
8314 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8315 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8316 @end deffn
8317
8318 @anchor{debuglevel}
8319 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8320 @cindex message level
8321 Display debug level.
8322 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8323 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8324 Level 0 is error messages only;
8325 level 1 adds warnings;
8326 level 2 adds informational messages;
8327 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8328 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8329 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8330 the command line along with the location of that log
8331 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8332 @xref{Running}.
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8336 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8337 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8338 @example
8339 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8340 @end example
8341 @end deffn
8342
8343 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8344 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8345 the default log output channel is stderr.
8346 @end deffn
8347
8348 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8349 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8350 @end deffn
8351
8352 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8353 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8354 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8355 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8356 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8357 @end deffn
8358
8359 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8360 @section Target State handling
8361 @cindex reset
8362 @cindex halt
8363 @cindex target initialization
8364
8365 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8366 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8367 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8368 a current target which is used to perform the
8369 various operations. The current target may be changed
8370 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8371 target which should become current.
8372
8373 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8374 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8375 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8376 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8377 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8378
8379 @emph{With no arguments}:
8380 list all available registers for the current target,
8381 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8382 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8383 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8384 are flagged as such.
8385
8386 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8387 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8388 bypassing any internal cache.
8389
8390 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8391 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8392 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8393 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8394 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8395 relevant module will flush such values.
8396
8397 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8398 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8399
8400 @example
8401 > reg
8402 ===== ARM registers
8403 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8404 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8405 (2) r2 (/32)
8406 ...
8407 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8408 >
8409 @end example
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8413 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8414 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8415 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8416 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8417 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8418 (and enter debug mode).
8419 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8420
8421 @quotation Warning
8422 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8423 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8424 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8425 power mode by gating the core clock;
8426 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8427
8428 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8429 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8430 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8431 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8432 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8433 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8434
8435 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8436 work with a JTAG debugger.
8437 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8438 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8439 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8440 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8441 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8442 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8443 @end quotation
8444
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8448 Resume the target at its current code position,
8449 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8450 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8454 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8455 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @anchor{resetcommand}
8459 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8460 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8461 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8462 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8463 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8464 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8465 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8466
8467 The optional parameter specifies what should
8468 happen after the reset.
8469 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8470 The other options will not work on all systems.
8471 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8472
8473 @itemize @minus
8474 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8475 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8476 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8477 @end itemize
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8481 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8482 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8483 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8484 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8485 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8486 state.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8490 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8491 Set values of reset signals.
8492 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8493 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8494 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8495 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8496
8497 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8498 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8499 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8500 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8501 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8502 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8503 the signal will not be modified.
8504
8505 @quotation Note
8506 TRST is specially handled.
8507 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8508 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8509 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8510 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8511 instead of the TRST signal.
8512 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8513 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8514 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8515 with handlers for that event.
8516 @end quotation
8517 @end deffn
8518
8519 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8520 @section Memory access commands
8521 @cindex memory access
8522
8523 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8524 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8525 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8526 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8527
8528 @enumerate
8529 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8530 to change the current target.
8531 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8532 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8533 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8534 @end enumerate
8535
8536 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8537 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8538 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8539 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8540 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8541 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8542 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8543 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8544 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8545 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8546 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8547 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8548 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8549 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8550 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8554 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8555 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8556 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8557 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8558 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8559 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8560 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8561 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8562 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8563 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8564 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @anchor{imageaccess}
8568 @section Image loading commands
8569 @cindex image loading
8570 @cindex image dumping
8571
8572 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8573 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8574 binary file named @var{filename}.
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8578 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8579 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8583 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8584 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8585 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8586 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8587 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8588 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8589 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8590 separately.
8591 @end deffn
8592
8593 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8594 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8595 The file format may optionally be specified
8596 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8597 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8598 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8599 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8600 @example
8601 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8602 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8603 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8604 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8605 $address $length
8606 @}
8607 @end example
8608 @end deffn
8609
8610 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8611 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8612 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8613 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8614 The file format may optionally be specified
8615 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8616 @end deffn
8617
8618 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8619 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8620 The file format may optionally be specified
8621 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8622 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8623 @end deffn
8624
8625 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8626 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8627 The file format may optionally be specified
8628 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8629 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8630 @end deffn
8631
8632
8633 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8634 @cindex breakpoint
8635 @cindex watchpoint
8636
8637 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8638 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8639 watchpoints.
8640 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8641
8642 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8643 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8644 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8645 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8646 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8647 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8648
8649 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8650 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8651 @end deffn
8652
8653 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8654 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8658 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8662 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8663 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8664 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8665 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8666 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8667 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8668 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8669 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8670 @end deffn
8671
8672
8673 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8674
8675 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8676 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8677 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8678 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8679 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8680 running, can be used.
8681 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8682 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8683 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8684
8685 @quotation Note
8686 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8687 @end quotation
8688
8689 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8690 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8691 communication, respectively.
8692
8693 @quotation Note
8694 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8695 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8696 example.
8697 @end quotation
8698
8699 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8700 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8701 of TCP/IP connections.
8702
8703 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8704 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8705 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8706 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8707 @var{size} bytes.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8711 Start RTT.
8712 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8713 @end deffn
8714
8715 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8716 Stop RTT.
8717 @end deffn
8718
8719 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8720 Display the polling interval.
8721 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8722 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8723 checked for new data.
8724 @end deffn
8725
8726 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8727 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8728 @end deffn
8729
8730 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8731 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8732 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8733 @end deffn
8734
8735 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8736 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8737 @end deffn
8738
8739 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8740 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8741 @end deffn
8742
8743 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8744 on the target device.
8745
8746 @example
8747 resume
8748
8749 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8750 rtt start
8751
8752 rtt server start 9090 0
8753 @end example
8754
8755 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8756 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8757 TCP/IP port 9090.
8758
8759
8760 @section Misc Commands
8761
8762 @cindex profiling
8763 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8764 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8765 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8766 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8767 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8768 limit the address range.
8769 @end deffn
8770
8771 @deffn {Command} {version}
8772 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8773 @end deffn
8774
8775 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8776 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8777 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8781 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
8782 @end deffn
8783
8784 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8785 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
8786 @end deffn
8787
8788 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8789 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8790 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8791 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8792
8793 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8794 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8795 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8796 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8797
8798 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8799 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8800 @cindex tracing
8801 @cindex ETM
8802 @cindex ETB
8803
8804 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8805 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8806 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8807
8808 @itemize
8809 @item
8810 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8811 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8812 supports such an interface.
8813 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8814 and trace port support.)
8815 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8816 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8817 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8818 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8819 in the board-specific configuration file.
8820 @item
8821 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8822 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8823 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8824 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8825 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8826 @end itemize
8827
8828 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8829
8830 @quotation Issues
8831 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8832 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8833
8834 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8835 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8836 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8837 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8838 dummy trace port driver}.
8839
8840 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8841 as well as tracing only during specific states
8842 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8843
8844 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8845 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8846 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8847 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8848 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8849
8850 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8851 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8852 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8853 this original style of JTAG access.
8854 @end quotation
8855
8856 @subsection ETM Configuration
8857 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8858
8859 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8860 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8861 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8862
8863 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8864 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8865 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8866 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8867 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8868 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8869 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8870 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8871 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8872
8873 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8874 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8875 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8876
8877 @quotation Warning
8878 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8879 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8880 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8881 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8882 @end quotation
8883
8884 @quotation Note
8885 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8886 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8887 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8888 what CPU activities are traced.
8889 @end quotation
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8893 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8894 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8895 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8896 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8897 @end deffn
8898
8899 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8900 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8901 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8902 Did trace data overflow?
8903 Was it triggered?
8904 @end deffn
8905
8906 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8907 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8908 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8909 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8910 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8911
8912 @itemize
8913 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8914 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8915 The value is one of
8916 @option{none} (save nothing),
8917 @option{data} (save data),
8918 @option{address} (save addresses),
8919 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8920 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8921 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8922 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8923 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8924 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8925 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8926 trace stream without an image of the code.
8927 @end itemize
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8931 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8932 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8933 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8934 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8935
8936 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8937 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8938 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8942
8943 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8944 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8945 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8946
8947 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8948 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8949 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8950 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8951 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8952 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8953 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8954
8955 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8956
8957 @itemize
8958 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8959 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8960 for instruction access within that function's body.
8961 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8962 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8963 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8964 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8965 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8966 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8967 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8968 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8969 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8970 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8971 @item @emph{... more}
8972 @end itemize
8973
8974 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8975 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8976
8977 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8978 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8979 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8983 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8984 @end deffn
8985
8986 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8987 Opens an image file.
8988 @end deffn
8989
8990 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8991 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8992 @end deffn
8993
8994 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8995 Starts trace data collection.
8996 @end deffn
8997
8998 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8999 Stops trace data collection.
9000 @end deffn
9001
9002 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9003 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9004
9005 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9006
9007 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9008 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9009 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9010 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9011 any trace data collection.}
9012 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9013 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9014 @end deffn
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9018 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9019 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9020 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9021 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9022 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9023 @end deffn
9024 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9025 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9026 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9027 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9028 trace trigger becomes active.
9029
9030 @itemize
9031 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9032 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9033 afterwards.
9034 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9035 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9036 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9037 what caused that event to happen.
9038 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9039 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9040 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9041 how the event caused trouble.
9042 @end itemize
9043 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9049 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9050 @cindex CTI
9051
9052 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9053 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9054 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9055 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9056 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9057 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9058
9059 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9060 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9061 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9062 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9063 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9064 including additional configuration.
9065 @end deffn
9066
9067 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9068 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9069 @end deffn
9070
9071 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9072 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9076 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9080 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9081 @end deffn
9082
9083 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9084 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9088 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9089 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9090 @end deffn
9091
9092 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9093 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9094 of the CTI.
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9098 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9099 useful in TCL scripting.
9100 @end deffn
9101
9102 @section Generic ARM
9103 @cindex ARM
9104
9105 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9106 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9107 commands that may be available.
9108
9109 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9110 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9111 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9112 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9113 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9114 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9118 @cindex disassemble
9119 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9120 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9121 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9122 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9123 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9124 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9125 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9126
9127 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9128 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9129 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9130 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9131 with a handful of exceptions.
9132 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9136 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9137 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9138 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9139 and using the MCR instruction.
9140 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9141 an ARM register.)
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9145 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9146 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9147 and the MRC instruction.
9148 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9149 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9150 an ARM register.)
9151 @end deffn
9152
9153 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9154 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9155 core mode if necessary.
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9159 @cindex ARM semihosting
9160 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9161
9162 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9163 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9164 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9165 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9166 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9167 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9168 @end deffn
9169
9170 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9171 @cindex ARM semihosting
9172 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9173
9174 @example
9175 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9176 @end example
9177
9178 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9179 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9180 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9181 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9185 @cindex ARM semihosting
9186 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9187 status.
9188
9189 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9190 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9191 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9192 debugger.
9193 @end deffn
9194
9195 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9196 @cindex ARM semihosting
9197 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9198
9199 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9200 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9201 the value returned by the target.
9202
9203 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9204 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9205 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9206 encountering a break.
9207
9208 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9209 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9210 to the debugger.
9211 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9212 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9213 request or equivalent").
9214
9215 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9216 this option (default: disabled).
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9220 @cindex ARMv4
9221 @cindex ARMv5
9222
9223 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9224 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9225 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9226 variant.
9227
9228 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9229 @cindex ARM7
9230 @cindex ARM9
9231
9232 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9233 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9234 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9235 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9236
9237 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9238 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9239 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9240 instead of breakpoints.
9241 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9242
9243 This should be
9244 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9245 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9246 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9247 @end deffn
9248
9249 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9250 @cindex DCC
9251 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9252 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9253 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9254
9255 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9256 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9257 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9261 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9262 that don't check completion of the operation.
9263 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9264
9265 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9266 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9267 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9268 @end deffn
9269
9270 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9271 @cindex ARM9
9272
9273 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9274 integer processors.
9275 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9276
9277 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9278 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9279 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9280 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9281
9282 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9283 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9284 @cindex vector_catch
9285 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9286 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9287 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9288 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9289 to those hardware vectors.
9290
9291 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9292 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9293 vector catch hardware to intercept
9294 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9295 @option{none} of them,
9296 or a list with one or more of the following:
9297 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9298 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9302 @cindex ARM920T
9303
9304 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9305 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9306 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9307 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9308 and ARM9 commands.
9309
9310 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9311 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9312 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9313 @end deffn
9314
9315 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9316 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9317 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9318 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9319 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9320 (Not all registers can be written.)
9321 @end deffn
9322
9323 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9324 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9325 @end deffn
9326
9327 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9328 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9329 @end deffn
9330
9331 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9332 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9333
9334 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9335 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9336 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9337 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9338 and ARM9 commands.
9339
9340 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9341 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9342
9343 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9344 Print information about the caches found.
9345 @end deffn
9346
9347 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9348 @cindex ARM966E
9349
9350 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9351 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9352 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9353 and ARM9 commands.
9354
9355 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9356 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9357 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9358 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9359 ARM966E-S TRM.
9360 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9361 as required for BIST support.
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @subsection XScale specific commands
9365 @cindex XScale
9366
9367 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9368
9369 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9370 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9371 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9372 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9373 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9374 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9375 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9376
9377 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9378 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9379 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9380 the mini-IC.
9381
9382 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9383 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9384 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9385 code layout in memory:
9386 @example
9387 _vectors:
9388 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9389 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9390 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9391 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9392 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9393 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9394 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9395 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9396 .org 0x100
9397 .long real_reset_vector
9398 .long real_ui_handler
9399 .long real_swi_handler
9400 .long real_pf_abort
9401 .long real_data_abort
9402 .long 0 /* unused */
9403 .long real_irq_handler
9404 .long real_fiq_handler
9405 @end example
9406
9407 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9408 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9409 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9410 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9411 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9412 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9413 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9414 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9415 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9416 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9417 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9418 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9419 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9420 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9421 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9422 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9423 software.
9424
9425 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9426 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9427 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9428 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9429
9430 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9431 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9432 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9433 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9434 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9435 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9436 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9437 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9438 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9439
9440 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9441 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9442
9443 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9444 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9448 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9452 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9453 @end deffn
9454
9455 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9456 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9457 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9461 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9462 @end deffn
9463
9464 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9465 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9466 @end deffn
9467
9468 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9469 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9470 @end deffn
9471
9472 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9473 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9477 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9481 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9482 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9483 and modifying how it is emptied.
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9487 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9488 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9489 The image @var{type} may be one of
9490 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9491 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9492 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9493 @end deffn
9494
9495 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9496 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9497 @cindex vector_catch
9498 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9499 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9500
9501 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9502 @example
9503 0x01 Trap Reset
9504 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9505 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9506 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9507 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9508 0x20 reserved
9509 0x40 Trap IRQ
9510 0x80 Trap FIQ
9511 @end example
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9515 @cindex vector_table
9516
9517 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9518 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9519 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9520 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9521 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9522
9523 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9524
9525 @end deffn
9526
9527 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9528 @cindex ARMv6
9529
9530 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9531 @cindex ARM11
9532
9533 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9534 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9535 which is enabled by default.
9536 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9537 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9538 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9539 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9540 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9541 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9545 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9546 which is enabled by default.
9547 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9548 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9549 @end deffn
9550
9551 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9552 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9553 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9554 they are disabled by default.
9555 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9556 @end deffn
9557
9558 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9559 @cindex vector_catch
9560 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9561 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9562 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9563
9564 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9565 for certain hardware events.
9566 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9567 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9568 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9572 @cindex ARMv7
9573 @cindex ARMv8
9574
9575 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9576 @cindex Cortex-A
9577
9578 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9579 display information about target caches
9580 @end deffn
9581
9582 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9583 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9584 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9585 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9586 Defaults to 'off'.
9587 @end deffn
9588
9589 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9590 Initialize core debug
9591 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9592 @end deffn
9593
9594 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9595 Display/set the current SMP mode
9596 @end deffn
9597
9598 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9599 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9603 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9604 @end deffn
9605
9606 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9607 configure l2x cache
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9611 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9612 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9613 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9614 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9615 @end deffn
9616
9617 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9618 @cindex Cortex-R
9619
9620 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9621 Initialize core debug
9622 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9623 @end deffn
9624
9625 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9626 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9627 @end deffn
9628
9629
9630 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9631 @cindex tracing
9632 @cindex SWO
9633 @cindex SWV
9634 @cindex TPIU
9635
9636 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9637 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9638 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9639 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9640
9641 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9642 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9643 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9644 which causes quite some confusion.
9645 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9646 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9647
9648 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9649 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9650 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9651
9652 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9653 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9654 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9655 @end deffn
9656
9657 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9658 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9659 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9660 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9661
9662 @itemize @bullet
9663 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9664 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9665 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9666 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9667
9668 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9669 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9670 @end itemize
9671 @end deffn
9672
9673 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9674 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9675 @end deffn
9676
9677 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9678 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9679 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9680 at any time after the initialization, too.
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9684 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9685 individually queried, to return its current value.
9686 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9687 @end deffn
9688
9689 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9690 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9691 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9692 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9693
9694 @itemize @bullet
9695 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9696 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9697
9698 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9699 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9700
9701 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9702 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9703
9704 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9705 protocol used for trace data:
9706 @itemize @minus
9707 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9708 data bits (default);
9709 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9710 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9711 @end itemize
9712
9713 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9714 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9715 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9716 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9717 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9718 of the TPIU.
9719
9720 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9721 the destination of the trace data:
9722 @itemize @minus
9723 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9724 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9725 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9726 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9727 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9728 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9729 each connected client;
9730 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9731 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9732 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9733 @end itemize
9734
9735 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9736 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9737 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9738 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9739
9740 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9741 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9742 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9743 maximum supported rate automatically.
9744
9745 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9746 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9747 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9748
9749 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9750 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9751 default value is @var{0}.
9752 @end itemize
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9756 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9757 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9758 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9759 data.
9760 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9761 after the @command{init}.
9762 @end deffn
9763
9764 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9765 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768
9769
9770 Example usage:
9771 @enumerate
9772 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9773 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9774 enough to:
9775 @example
9776 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9777 ...
9778 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9779 ...
9780 @end example
9781 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9782 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9783 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9784 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9785 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9786 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9787 @example
9788 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9789 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9790 @end example
9791 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9792 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9793 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9794 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9795 @example
9796 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9797 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9798 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9799 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9800 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9801 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9802 @end example
9803 @end enumerate
9804
9805 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9806 @cindex tracing
9807 @cindex SWO
9808 @cindex SWV
9809 @cindex ITM
9810 @cindex ETM
9811
9812 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9813 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9814 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9818 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9819 @end deffn
9820
9821 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9822 @cindex Cortex-M
9823
9824 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9825 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9826
9827 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9828 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9829 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9830 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9831 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9832 the step command leaves with the core running.
9833
9834 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9835 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9836 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9837 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9838
9839 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9840 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9841 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9842 does.
9843
9844 Default is @option{auto}.
9845 @end deffn
9846
9847 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9848 @cindex vector_catch
9849 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9850 for certain hardware events.
9851
9852 Parameters request interception of
9853 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9854 @option{none} of them,
9855 or one or more of the following:
9856 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9857 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9858 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9859 @option{irq_err},
9860 @option{state_err},
9861 @option{chk_err}, or
9862 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9863 @option{reset}.
9864 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9865 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9866 are mapped to HardFault.
9867 UsageFault checks for
9868 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9869 must also be explicitly enabled.
9870
9871 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9872 @end deffn
9873
9874 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9875 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9876 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9877
9878 @itemize @minus
9879 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9880 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9881 @end itemize
9882
9883 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9884 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9885 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9886 to manually reset the peripherals.
9887 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9888
9889 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9890 instead.
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9894 @cindex ARMv8-A
9895 @cindex aarch64
9896
9897 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9898 Display information about target caches
9899 @end deffn
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9902 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9903 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9904 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9905 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9906 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9910 @cindex disassemble
9911 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9912 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9916 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9917 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9918 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9919 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9920 @end deffn
9921
9922 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9923 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9924 @option{on}.
9925 @end deffn
9926
9927 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9928 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9929 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9930 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9931 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9932 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9933 @end deffn
9934
9935 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9936
9937 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9938 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9939
9940 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9941
9942 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9943 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9944 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9945 @end deffn
9946
9947 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9948 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9949 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9950 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9951 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9952 @end deffn
9953
9954 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9957 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9958 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9962
9963 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9964 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9965 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9966 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9967 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9968 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9969 can be collected.
9970
9971 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9972 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9973 tooling.
9974
9975 @quotation Issues
9976 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9977 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9978 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9979 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9980
9981 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9982 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9983 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9984 software operation on the CPU.
9985 @end quotation
9986
9987 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9988 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9989 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9990 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9991 @end deffn
9992
9993 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9994 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9995 @end deffn
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9998 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9999 control is disabled.
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10003 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10004 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10005 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10006
10007 Supported trace formats:
10008 @itemize
10009 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10010 timing to be determined.
10011 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10012 addresses.
10013 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10014 @end itemize
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10018 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10019 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10020 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10021
10022 Supported conditions:
10023 @itemize
10024 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10025 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10026 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10027 instruction matches start data and mask.
10028 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10029 instruction matches start data and mask.
10030 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10031 data and mask.
10032 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10033 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10034 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10035 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10036 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10037 @end itemize
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10041 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10042 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10043 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10044
10045 Supported conditions:
10046 @itemize
10047 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10048 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10049 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10050 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10051 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10052 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10053 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10054 data and mask.
10055 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10056 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10057 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10058 @end itemize
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10062 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10063
10064 Supported triggers:
10065 @itemize
10066 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10067 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10068 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10069 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10070 collection.
10071 @end itemize
10072 @end deffn
10073
10074 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10075
10076 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10077 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10078 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10079 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10080 @end deffn
10081
10082 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10083 Display trace configuration.
10084 @end deffn
10085
10086 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10087 Display trace collection status.
10088 @end deffn
10089
10090 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10091 Start manual trace collection.
10092 @end deffn
10093
10094 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10095 Stop manual trace collection.
10096 @end deffn
10097
10098 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10099 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10100 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10101 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10102 @option{size} options using DMA.
10103 @end deffn
10104
10105 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10106 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10107 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10108 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10109 @option{size} options using DMA.
10110 @end deffn
10111
10112 @section Intel Architecture
10113
10114 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10115 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10116 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10117 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10118 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10119 @itemize
10120 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10121 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10122 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10123 @end itemize
10124
10125 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10126 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10127 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10128
10129 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10130 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10131 @end deffn
10132
10133 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10134 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10135 @end deffn
10136
10137 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10138 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10139 @end deffn
10140
10141 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10142 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10143 @end deffn
10144
10145 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10146 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10147 @end deffn
10148
10149 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10150 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10151 @end deffn
10152
10153 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10154
10155 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10156 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10157
10158 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10159 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10160 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10161 @end deffn
10162 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10163 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10164
10165 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10166
10167 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10168 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10169 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10170 @end deffn
10171
10172 @subsection Registers commands
10173 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10174 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10175 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10176
10177 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10178
10179 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10180 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10181 and "timer" groups.
10182
10183 @emph{example:}
10184 @example
10185 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10186 @end example
10187
10188 @end deffn
10189
10190 @section RISC-V Architecture
10191
10192 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10193 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10194 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10195 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10196 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10197 implement version 0.11.
10198
10199 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10200
10201 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10202 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10203 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10204
10205 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10206
10207 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10208 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10209 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10210
10211 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10212 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10213 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10214 CSRs.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10218 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10219 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10220 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10221 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10222 This command must be executed before `init`.
10223 @end deffn
10224
10225 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10226 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10227 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10228 @end deffn
10229
10230 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10231 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10232 deasserted.
10233 @end deffn
10234
10235 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10236 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10237 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10238 @end deffn
10239
10240 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10241 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10242 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10243 on physical memory.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10247 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10248 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10249 performed on physical memory.
10250 @end deffn
10251
10252 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10253 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10254 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10255 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10256 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10257 race condition problem in your code.
10258
10259 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10260 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10261 @end deffn
10262
10263 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10264 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10265 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10266 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10267 values.
10268
10269 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10270 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10271 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10272 @end deffn
10273
10274 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10275 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10276 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10280 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10281 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10282 @end deffn
10283
10284 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10285 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10286 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10287 @end deffn
10288
10289 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10290 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10291 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10292 @end deffn
10293
10294 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10295
10296 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10297 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10298 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10299 @example
10300 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10301 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10302 @end example
10303
10304 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10305 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10306 @end deffn
10307
10308 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10309 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10310 @end deffn
10311
10312 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10313
10314 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10315 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10316
10317 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10318 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10319 @end deffn
10320
10321 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10322 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10323 @end deffn
10324
10325 @section ARC Architecture
10326 @cindex ARC
10327
10328 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10329 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10330 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10331 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10332 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10333 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10334 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10335 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10336 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10337 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10338 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10339 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10340 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10341 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10342 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10343
10344
10345 @subsection General ARC commands
10346
10347 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10348
10349 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10350 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10351 arguments:
10352
10353 @itemize @bullet
10354
10355 @item @code{-name} name
10356 @*Name of a register.
10357
10358 @item @code{-num} number
10359 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10360
10361 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10362 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10363
10364 @end itemize
10365
10366 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10367
10368 @itemize @bullet
10369
10370 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10371 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10372 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10373 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10374 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10375 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10376
10377 @item @code{-core}
10378 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10379 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10380 spaces.
10381
10382 @item @code{-bcr}
10383 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10384 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10385 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10386 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10387 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10388
10389 @item @code{-type} type_name
10390 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10391 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10392
10393 @item @code{-g}
10394 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10395 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10396 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10397 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10398 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10399
10400 @end itemize
10401
10402 @end deffn
10403
10404 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10405 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10406 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10410 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10411 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10412 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10413 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10414 startbit endbit}.
10415 @end deffn
10416
10417 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10418 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10419 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10420 @end deffn
10421
10422 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10423 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10424 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10425 @end deffn
10426
10427 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10428
10429 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10430 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10431 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10432 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10433
10434 @end deffn
10435
10436 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10437 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10438 registers.
10439 @end deffn
10440
10441 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10442 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10443 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10444 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10445
10446 @end deffn
10447
10448 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10449 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10450 registers.
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453 @section STM8 Architecture
10454 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10455 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10456
10457 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10458 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10459
10460 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10461 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10462 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10463 @cindex tracing
10464 @cindex libdcc
10465 @cindex DCC
10466 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10467 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10468 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10469 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10470
10471 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10472 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10473 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10474 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10475 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10476 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10477
10478 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10479 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10480 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10481 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10482 The target being debugged may
10483 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10484 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10485 each supported by a command:
10486
10487 @itemize
10488 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10489 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10490 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10491 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10492
10493 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10494 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10495 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10496
10497 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10498 and then displayed at any time.
10499 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10500
10501 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10502 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10503 @end itemize
10504
10505 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10506 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10507 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10508 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10509 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10510 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10511 does the same thing.
10512
10513 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10514 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10515 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10516 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10517 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10518
10519 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10520 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10521 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10522 @end deffn
10523
10524 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10525 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10526 in the order they triggered.
10527 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10528 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10529 history records.
10530 @end deffn
10531
10532 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10533 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10534 they have been triggered.
10535 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10536 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10537 and associates it with that identifier.
10538
10539 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10540 are not related except by this command.
10541 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10542 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10543 @end deffn
10544
10545
10546 @node JTAG Commands
10547 @chapter JTAG Commands
10548 @cindex JTAG Commands
10549 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10550 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10551 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10552 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10553 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10554
10555 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10556 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10557
10558 @itemize @bullet
10559 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10560 devices such as a CPUs.
10561 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10562 standard state machine (in parallel)
10563 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10564 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10565 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10566 while the reading previous ones.
10567 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10568 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10569 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10570 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10571 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10572 registers.
10573 @end itemize
10574
10575 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10576
10577 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10578 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10579 the order of TAP state transitions.
10580 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10581 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10582 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10583 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10584 these commands are not available.
10585
10586 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10587 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10588 that specify the entire register.
10589 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10590 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10591 The return value holds the original value of each
10592 of those fields.
10593
10594 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10595 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10596 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10597 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10598 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10599
10600 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10601 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10602
10603 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10604 in that state.
10605 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10606 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10607 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10608
10609 @quotation Warning
10610 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10611 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10612 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10613 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10614 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10615 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10616 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10617 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10618 @end quotation
10619 @end deffn
10620
10621 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10622 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10623 This may be used for performance tuning.
10624
10625 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10626 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10627 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10628 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10629 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10630 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10631 @end deffn
10632
10633 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10634 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10635 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10636 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10637 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10638 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10639
10640 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10641 in that state.
10642 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10643 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10644 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10645
10646 @quotation Note
10647 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10648 register values, unlike data register values.
10649 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10650 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10651 @end quotation
10652 @end deffn
10653
10654 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10655 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10656 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10657 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10658 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10659 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10660 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10661 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10662 The final state must also be stable.
10663 @end deffn
10664
10665 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10666 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10667 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10668 Instructions often need some time
10669 to execute before they take effect.
10670 @end deffn
10671
10672 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10673 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10674
10675 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10676 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10677 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10678 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10679 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10680 @end deffn
10681
10682 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10683 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10684 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10685 must also be enabled.
10686 Default is enabled.
10687 @end deffn
10688
10689 @section TAP state names
10690 @cindex TAP state names
10691
10692 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10693 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10694 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10695 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10696
10697 @itemize @bullet
10698 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10699 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10700 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10701 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10702 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10703 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10704 through the data register
10705 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10706 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10707 for update or more shifting
10708 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10709 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10710 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10711 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10712 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10713 through the instruction register
10714 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10715 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10716 for update or more shifting
10717 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10718 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10719 @end itemize
10720
10721 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10722 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10723 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10724 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10725
10726 @itemize @bullet
10727 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10728 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10729 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10730 may not be as expected.
10731 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10732 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10733 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10734 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10735 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10736 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10737 @end itemize
10738
10739 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10740 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10741
10742 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10743 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10744 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10745 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10746
10747 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10748 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10749 @cindex SVF
10750
10751 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10752 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10753 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10754 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10755
10756 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10757 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10758 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10759 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10760
10761 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10762 affect their semantics.
10763
10764 Command options:
10765 @itemize @minus
10766 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10767 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10768 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10769 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10770 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10771 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10772 on the real interface;
10773 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10774 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10775 errors.
10776 @end itemize
10777 @end deffn
10778
10779 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10780 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10781 @cindex XSVF
10782
10783 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10784 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10785 Xilinx devices.
10786 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10787 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10788
10789 @quotation Important
10790 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10791 @end quotation
10792
10793 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10794 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10795 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10796 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10797 that TAP.
10798 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10799 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10800 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10801 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10802 @end deffn
10803
10804 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10805 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10806 after building the software.
10807 You may find them useful:
10808
10809 @itemize
10810 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10811 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10812 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10813 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10814 @end itemize
10815
10816 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10817 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10818 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10819 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10820 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10821 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10822 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10823
10824
10825 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10826 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10827 @cindex IPDBG
10828
10829 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10830 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10831 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10832 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10833 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10834 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10835
10836 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10837 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10838
10839 Command options:
10840 @itemize @bullet
10841 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10842 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10843 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10844 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10845 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10846 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10847 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10848 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10849 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10850 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10851 shift data through vir can be configured.
10852 @end itemize
10853 @end deffn
10854
10855 Examples:
10856 @example
10857 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10858 @end example
10859 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10860 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10861
10862 @example
10863 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10864 @end example
10865 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10866 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10867
10868 @node Utility Commands
10869 @chapter Utility Commands
10870 @cindex Utility Commands
10871
10872 @section RAM testing
10873 @cindex RAM testing
10874
10875 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10876 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10877 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10878 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10879 hardware problems.
10880
10881 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10882 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10883 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10884 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10885
10886 Load the memory testing functions with
10887
10888 @example
10889 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10890 @end example
10891
10892 to get access to the following facilities:
10893
10894 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10895 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10896 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10897 @end deffn
10898
10899 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10900 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10901 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10902 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10903 @end deffn
10904
10905 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10906 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10907 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10908 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10909 @end deffn
10910
10911 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10912 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10913 @end deffn
10914
10915 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10916 @cindex Firmware recovery
10917
10918 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10919 devices recovery with JTAG.
10920
10921 For quickstart instructions run:
10922 @example
10923 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10924 @end example
10925
10926 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10927 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10928 @cindex GDB
10929 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10930 to debug remote targets.
10931 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10932
10933 @itemize
10934 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10935 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10936 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10937 as shown in this chapter.
10938 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10939 that also will probably need to be configured.
10940 @end itemize
10941
10942 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10943 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10944 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10945 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10946 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10947 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10948
10949 @section Connecting to GDB
10950 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10951 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10952 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10953 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10954 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10955
10956 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10957
10958 @enumerate
10959 @item
10960 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10961 @example
10962 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10963 @end example
10964 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10965
10966 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10967 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10968 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10969
10970 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10971 remote command above that becomes:
10972 @example
10973 tar ext :3333
10974 @end example
10975
10976 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10977 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10978 available through the command:
10979 @example
10980 target remote localhost:3333
10981 @end example
10982
10983 @item
10984 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10985 @example
10986 target extended-remote | \
10987 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10988 @end example
10989 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10990 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10991 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10992 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10993 @end enumerate
10994
10995 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10996 GDB command line.
10997
10998 @section Sample GDB session startup
10999
11000 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11001 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11002 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11003 small ARM program.
11004 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11005 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11006
11007 @example
11008 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11009 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11010 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11011 ...
11012 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11013 ...
11014 (gdb) load
11015 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11016 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11017 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11018 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11019 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11020 (gdb) continue
11021 Continuing.
11022 ...
11023 @end example
11024
11025 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11026 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11027 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11028 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11029
11030 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11031
11032 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11033 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11034 packet size and the device's memory map.
11035 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11036 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11037 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11038
11039 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11040 You may need to set those up by hand.
11041 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11042 something like:
11043
11044 @example
11045 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11046 @end example
11047
11048 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11049
11050 @example
11051 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11052 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11053 @end example
11054
11055 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11056 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11057 do not have such restrictions.
11058
11059 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11060 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11061 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11062 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11063
11064 @section Programming using GDB
11065 @cindex Programming using GDB
11066 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11067
11068 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11069 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11070 @example
11071 gdb_memory_map disable
11072 @end example
11073 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11074 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11075 working area.
11076
11077 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11078 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11079 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11080 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11081
11082 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11083 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11084
11085 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11086 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11087 @example
11088 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11089 @end example
11090
11091 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11092 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11093
11094 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11095 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11096 will be used.
11097
11098 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11099 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11100 @example
11101 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11102 @end example
11103 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11104
11105 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11106 can be used.
11107
11108 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11109 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11110 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11111
11112 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11113 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11114 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11115
11116 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11117 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11118 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11119 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11120 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11121 without any intrusion of the target process.
11122
11123 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11124 Place following command after target configuration:
11125 @example
11126 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11127 @end example
11128
11129 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11130 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11131 @example
11132 gdb_memory_map disable
11133 @end example
11134
11135 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11136 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11137 @example
11138 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11139 @end example
11140
11141 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11142 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11143
11144 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11145 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11146 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11147 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11148
11149 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11150 previously shown variables.
11151
11152 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11153 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11154 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11155 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11156 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11157
11158 @section RTOS Support
11159 @cindex RTOS Support
11160 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11161
11162 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11163 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11164
11165 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11166 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11167 GDB commands.
11168
11169 @* An example setup is below:
11170
11171 @example
11172 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11173 @end example
11174
11175 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11176
11177 Currently supported rtos's include:
11178 @itemize @bullet
11179 @item @option{eCos}
11180 @item @option{ThreadX}
11181 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11182 @item @option{linux}
11183 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11184 @item @option{embKernel}
11185 @item @option{mqx}
11186 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11187 @item @option{nuttx}
11188 @item @option{RIOT}
11189 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11190 @item @option{Zephyr}
11191 @end itemize
11192
11193 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11194 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11195
11196 @table @code
11197 @item eCos symbols
11198 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11199 @item ThreadX symbols
11200 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11201 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11202 @raggedright
11203 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11204 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11205 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11206 @end raggedright
11207 @item linux symbols
11208 init_task.
11209 @item ChibiOS symbols
11210 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11211 @item embKernel symbols
11212 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11213 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11214 @item mqx symbols
11215 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11216 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11217 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11218 @item nuttx symbols
11219 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11220 @item RIOT symbols
11221 @raggedright
11222 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11223 _tcb_name_offset.
11224 @end raggedright
11225 @item Zephyr symbols
11226 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11227 @end table
11228
11229 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11230 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11231
11232 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11233 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11234
11235 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11236 along with the project:
11237
11238 @table @code
11239 @item FreeRTOS
11240 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11241 @item uC/OS-III
11242 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11243 @end table
11244
11245 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11246 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11247 @cindex SMP
11248 @cindex RTOS
11249 @cindex hwthread
11250 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11251 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11252 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11253 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11254 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11255 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11256 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11257 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11258 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11259
11260 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11261 @quotation Note
11262 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11263 @end quotation
11264
11265 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11266 @itemize @bullet
11267 @item j - smp status request
11268 @item J - smp set request
11269 @end itemize
11270
11271 OpenOCD implements :
11272 @itemize @bullet
11273 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11274 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11275 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11276 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11277 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11278 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11279 @end itemize
11280
11281 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11282 @itemize @bullet
11283 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11284 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11285 @example
11286 set $_core 1
11287 #Jc01 packet is sent
11288 print $_core
11289 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11290 @end example
11291
11292 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11293 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11294
11295 @example
11296 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11297 define toggle0
11298 maint packet Jc0
11299 continue
11300 main packet Jc-1
11301 end
11302 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11303 define toggle1
11304 maint packet Jc1
11305 continue
11306 main packet Jc-1
11307 end
11308 @end example
11309 @end itemize
11310
11311 @node Tcl Scripting API
11312 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11313 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11314 @cindex Tcl scripts
11315 @section API rules
11316
11317 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11318 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11319 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11320
11321 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11322 pair list and lists.
11323
11324 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11325 list.
11326
11327 @example
11328 > set foo(me) Duane
11329 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11330 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11331 > set foo(duck) Donald
11332 @end example
11333
11334 If one does this:
11335
11336 @example
11337 > set foo
11338 @end example
11339
11340 The result is:
11341
11342 @example
11343 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11344 @end example
11345
11346 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11347
11348 @verbatim
11349 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11350 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11351 }
11352 @end verbatim
11353
11354 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11355 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11356
11357 @section Internal low-level Commands
11358
11359 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11360 invoke directly.
11361
11362 @itemize @bullet
11363 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11364
11365 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11366 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11367
11368 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11369 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11370
11371 Return information about the flash banks
11372
11373 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11374
11375 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11376 its execution. Example:
11377
11378 @example
11379 > capture "reset init"
11380 @end example
11381
11382 @end itemize
11383
11384 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11385 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11386 called "flash_banks".
11387
11388 @section Tcl RPC server
11389 @cindex RPC
11390
11391 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11392 commands and receive the results.
11393
11394 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11395 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11396 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11397 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11398 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11399
11400 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11401 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11402 @command{capture} command.
11403
11404 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11405
11406 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11407 @cindex RPC Notifications
11408
11409 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11410 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11411
11412 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11413 in the following format.
11414
11415 @verbatim
11416 type target_event event [event-name]
11417 type target_state state [state-name]
11418 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11419 @end verbatim
11420
11421 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11422 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11423 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11424 Defaults to off.
11425
11426 @end deffn
11427
11428 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11429 @cindex RPC trace output
11430
11431 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11432 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11433
11434 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11435
11436 @verbatim
11437 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11438 @end verbatim
11439
11440 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11441 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11442 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11443 Defaults to off.
11444
11445 See an example application here:
11446 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11447
11448 @end deffn
11449
11450 @node FAQ
11451 @chapter FAQ
11452 @cindex faq
11453 @enumerate
11454 @anchor{faqrtck}
11455 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11456 @cindex RTCK
11457 @cindex adaptive clocking
11458 @*
11459
11460 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11461 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11462 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11463 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11464
11465 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11466 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11467 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11468 @enumerate
11469 @item
11470 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11471 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11472 @item
11473 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11474 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11475 @end enumerate
11476
11477 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11478 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11479 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11480 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11481 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11482 power).
11483
11484 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11485 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11486 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11487 ARM926 scenario).
11488 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11489 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11490 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11491
11492 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11493 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11494 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11495 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11496
11497 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11498
11499 In order to make use of this,
11500 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11501 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11502
11503 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11504 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11505 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11506 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11507 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11508
11509 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11510 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11511 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11512 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11513
11514 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11515 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11516 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11517 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11518 with a CPLD.
11519 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11520 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11521 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11522 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11523 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11524 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11525
11526 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11527
11528 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11529
11530 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11531 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11532 depending on the chips on your board.
11533 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11534 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11535 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11536
11537 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11538 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11539 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11540
11541 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11542 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11543 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11544 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11545
11546 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11547 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11548 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11549 this way.
11550
11551 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11552 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11553 clock rate.
11554 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11555 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11556 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11557
11558 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11559
11560 @example
11561 # Example: 1.234MHz
11562 adapter speed 1234
11563 @end example
11564
11565
11566 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11567
11568 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11569 around Windows filenames.
11570
11571 @example
11572 > echo \a
11573
11574 > echo @{\a@}
11575 \a
11576 > echo "\a"
11577
11578 >
11579 @end example
11580
11581
11582 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11583
11584 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11585 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11586 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11587
11588 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11589 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11590 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11591
11592 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11593 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11594 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11595
11596 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11597
11598 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11599 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11600 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11601 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11602
11603 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11604 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11605 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11606
11607 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11608 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11609
11610 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11611 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11612 memory read caused data abort".
11613
11614 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11615 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11616 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11617 be done, feel free to add this here.
11618
11619 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11620 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11621 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11622 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11623 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11624 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11625 gracefully stops.
11626
11627 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11628 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11629 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11630
11631 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11632 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11633 bytes. Painful...
11634
11635
11636 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11637 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11638
11639 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11640 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11641 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11642 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11643 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11644 reset, everything else should work fine.
11645
11646 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11647 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11648 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11649 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11650
11651 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11652 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11653 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11654 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11655
11656 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11657
11658 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11659 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11660 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11661
11662 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11663 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11664
11665 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11666 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11667 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11668 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11669 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11670 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11671 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11672 clock frequency?
11673
11674 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11675 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11676 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11677 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11678 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11679
11680 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11681
11682 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11683 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11684 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11685 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11686 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11687 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11688 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11689
11690 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11691
11692 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11693 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11694 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11695 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11696
11697 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11698 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11699 particular order?
11700
11701 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11702 the same order used by the hardware.
11703
11704 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11705 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11706 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11707 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11708 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11709 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11710
11711 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11712 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11713 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11714 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11715
11716 @itemize @bullet
11717 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11718 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11719 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11720 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11721 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11722 @end itemize
11723
11724 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11725
11726 @itemize @bullet
11727 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11728 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11729 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11730 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11731 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11732 @end itemize
11733
11734
11735 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11736 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11737 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11738
11739 TODO.
11740
11741 @end enumerate
11742
11743 @node Tcl Crash Course
11744 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11745 @cindex Tcl
11746
11747 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11748 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11749 how the Tcl scripts work.
11750
11751 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11752 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11753 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11754 OpenOCD.
11755
11756 @section Tcl Rule #1
11757 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11758 @enumerate
11759 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11760 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11761 @end enumerate
11762
11763 The Tcl equal is this:
11764
11765 @enumerate
11766 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11767 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11768 @end enumerate
11769
11770 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11771 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11772
11773 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11774 There is a second pair of rules.
11775 @enumerate
11776 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11777 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11778 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11779 in Tcl.
11780 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11781 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11782 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11783 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11784 @end enumerate
11785
11786 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11787 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11788 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11789 Everything is a string}
11790
11791 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11792 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11793 difference is subtle.
11794 @enumerate
11795 @item Parse Time
11796 @item Evaluation Time
11797 @end enumerate
11798
11799 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11800 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11801 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11802
11803 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11804 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11805 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11806 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11807
11808 @itemize @bullet
11809 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11810 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11811 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11812 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11813 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11814 @example
11815 # bash example
11816 X=`date`
11817 echo "The Date is: $X"
11818 # Tcl example
11819 set X [date]
11820 puts "The Date is: $X"
11821 @end example
11822 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11823 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11824 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11825 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11826 is a string}
11827 @example
11828 set x "Dinner"
11829 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11830 @end example
11831 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11832 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11833 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11834 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11835 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11836 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11837 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11838 @end itemize
11839
11840 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11841
11842 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11843
11844 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11845
11846 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11847 the normal way.
11848
11849 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11850 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11851 line is immediately executed.
11852
11853 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11854 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11855
11856 @subsection Command Execution
11857
11858 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11859 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11860 control flow operators.
11861
11862 Commands are executed like this:
11863
11864 @enumerate
11865 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11866 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11867 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11868 @end enumerate
11869
11870 It sort of works like this:
11871 @example
11872 for(;;)@{
11873 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11874
11875 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11876
11877 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11878 @}
11879 @end example
11880
11881 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11882 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11883 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11884 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11885 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11886 ``LookupCommand()''
11887
11888 @subsection The FOR command
11889
11890 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11891 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11892 command just like any other command.
11893
11894 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11895 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11896 are:
11897
11898 @enumerate 0
11899 @item The ascii text 'for'
11900 @item The start text
11901 @item The test expression
11902 @item The next text
11903 @item The body text
11904 @end enumerate
11905
11906 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11907 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11908 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11909 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11910
11911 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11912 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11913
11914 @example
11915 int
11916 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11917 int *argc,
11918 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11919 @end example
11920
11921 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11922 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11923 still operates in the same basic way.
11924
11925 @subsection FOR command implementation
11926
11927 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11928 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11929
11930 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11931
11932 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11933
11934 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11935 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11936 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11937
11938 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11939 expression and returns a value.
11940
11941 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11942 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11943 @example
11944 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11945
11946 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11947
11948 int
11949 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11950 int argc,
11951 char **argv )
11952 @{
11953 if( argc != 5 )@{
11954 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11955 return ERROR;
11956 @}
11957
11958 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11959
11960 // Execute the start statement.
11961 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11962
11963 // Top of loop test
11964 for(;;)@{
11965 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11966 if( i == 0 )
11967 break;
11968
11969 // Execute the body
11970 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11971
11972 // Execute the LOOP part
11973 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11974 @}
11975
11976 // Return no error
11977 SetResult( interp, "" );
11978 return SUCCESS;
11979 @}
11980 @end example
11981
11982 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11983 in the same basic way.
11984
11985 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11986
11987 @subsection source and find commands
11988 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11989 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11990 @*Remember the parsing rules
11991 @enumerate
11992 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11993 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11994 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11995 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11996 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11997 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11998 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11999 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12000 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12001 @end enumerate
12002 @subsection format command
12003 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12004 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12005 @b{sprintf()}.
12006 @b{Example}
12007 @example
12008 set x 6
12009 set y 7
12010 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
12011 @end example
12012 @enumerate
12013 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12014 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12015 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12016 @* Refer to Rule #1
12017 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12018 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12019 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12020 @end enumerate
12021 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12022 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12023 @example
12024 #1 Good
12025 proc someproc @{@} @{
12026 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12027 @}
12028 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12029 #2 Good - no variables
12030 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12031 #3 Good Curly Braces
12032 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12033 puts "Time: [date]"
12034 @}
12035 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12036 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12037 @end example
12038 @enumerate
12039 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12040 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12041 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12042 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12043 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12044 command.
12045 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12046 @*There are 4 examples:
12047 @enumerate
12048 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12049 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12050 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12051 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12052 @end enumerate
12053
12054 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12055 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12056 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12057
12058 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12059 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12060 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12061 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12062 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12063 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12064 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12065 @end enumerate
12066 @subsection Global Variables
12067 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12068 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12069 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12070 @example
12071 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12072 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12073 global x #Global variable X
12074 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12075 @}
12076 @end example
12077 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12078 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12079 @example
12080 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12081 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12082 # Create var name
12083 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12084 # Make it a global
12085 global $vn
12086 # Set it.
12087 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12088 @}
12089 @end example
12090 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12091 @example
12092 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12093 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12094 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12095 @}
12096 @end example
12097
12098 @node License
12099 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12100 @include fdl.texi
12101
12102 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12103 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12104 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12105 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12106 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12107 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12108
12109 @printindex cp
12110
12111 @node Command and Driver Index
12112 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12113 @printindex fn
12114
12115 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)